Professional Documents
Culture Documents
PowerTech 4.5 & 6.8 L Diesel EnginesLevel 12 Electronic Fuel System with DE10 Pump CTM331 09APR02 (English)
POWERTECH 4.5L & 6.8L Diesel Engines Level 12 Electronic Fuel System With Stanadyne DE10 Pump
TECHNICAL MANUAL POWERTECH 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel EnginesLevel 12 Electronic Fuel System with DE10 Pump
CTM331 09APR02 (ENGLISH)
For complete service information also see: POWERTECH 4.5 L and 6.8 L Diesel EnginesBase Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CTM104 Alternators and Starter Motors . . . . . . . . . . . CTM77 OEM Engine Accessories . . . . . . CTM67 (English Only)
Introduction
Forward
This manual is written for an experienced technician. Essential tools required in performing certain service work are identified in this manual and are recommended for use. This manual (CTM331) covers only Level 12 Electronic Fuel System with the Stanadyne DE10 injection pump. It is one of five volumes on 4.5 L and 6.8 L engines. The following four companion manuals cover the base engine, mechanical fuel system, level 4 electronic fuel system and level 1 electronic fuel system repair, operation and diagnostics: CTM104Base Engine CTM170Level 4 Electronic Fuel System with Bosch VP44 Pump CTM207Mechanical Fuel Systems CTM284Level 1 Electronic Fuel Systems with Delphi (Lucas) DP201 Pump Other manuals will be added in the future to provide additional information on electronic fuel systems as needed. Live with safety: Read the safety messages in the introduction of this manual and the cautions presented throughout the text of the manual. This is the safety-alert symbol. When you see this symbol on the machine or in this manual, be alert to the potential for personal injury. Use this component technical manual in conjunction with the machine technical manual. An application listing in Section 01, Group 001 identifies product-model/component type-model relationship. See the machine technical manual for information on component removal and installation, and gaining access to the components. Information is organized in sections and groups for the various components requiring service instruction. Section 05 summarizes all applicable essential tools, service equipment and tools, other materials needed to do the job, and service parts kits. Section 06 summarizes all specifications, wear tolerances, and torque values. Before beginning diagnosis or repair on an engine, clean the engine. This manual contains SI Metric units of measure followed immediately by the U.S. customary units of measure. Most hardware on these engines is metric sized. Some components of this engine may be serviced without removing the engine from the machine. Refer to the specific machine technical manual for information on components that can be serviced without removing the engine from the machine and for engine removal and installation procedures. Read each block of material completely before performing service to check for differences in procedures or specifications. Follow only the procedures that apply to the engine model number you are working on. If only one procedure is given, that procedure applies to all the engines in the manual. CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING Diesel engine exhaust and some of its constituents are known to the State of California to cause cancer, birth defects and other reproductive harm.
OUO1080,00001FE 1916NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
PN=2
Introduction
POWERTECH 4.5 L Engine with Level 12 Electronic Fuel System and Stanadyne DE10 Pump
UN06NOV01
RG11931
DPSG,OUO1004,129 1915MAY981/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
PN=3
RG11932
UN06NOV01
Introduction
CTM331 (09APR02)
PN=4
Contents
01
SECTION 01General Information Group 000Safety Group 001Engine Identification Group 002Fuels SECTION 02Repair and Adjustments Group 090Electronic Fuel System Repair and Adjustments Group 110Electrical Engine Control Repair and Adjustment SECTION 03Theory of Operation Group 130Electronic Fuel System Operation Group 140Electronic Control System Operation SECTION 04Diagnostics Group 150Observable Diagnostics and Tests Group 160Trouble Code Diagnostics and Tests SECTION 05Tools and Other Materials Group 170Electronic Fuel/Control System Repair Tools and Other Materials Group 180Diagnostic Service Tools SECTION 06Specifications Group 200Repair Specifications Group 210Diagnostic Specifications
04 02
03
05
06
INDX
All information, illustrations and specifications in this manual are based on the latest information available at the time of publication. The right is reserved to make changes at any time without notice.
COPYRIGHT 2002 DEERE & COMPANY Moline, Illinois All rights reserved A John Deere ILLUSTRUCTION Manual
CTM331 (09APR02)
PN=1
Contents
01
02
03
04
05
06
INDX
CTM331 (09APR02)
ii
PN=2
01
Section 01
General Information
Contents
Page
Group 000Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-000-1 Group 001Engine Identification Engine Model Designation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-1 Engine Serial Number Plate Information . . . . .01-001-2 OEM Engine Option Code Label . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-3 Information Relative to Emissions Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-3 Engine Application Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-4 Group 002Fuels Lubricants and Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1 Diesel Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1 Bio-Diesel Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-2 Dieselscan Fuel Analysis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-2 Lubricity of Diesel Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-3
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-1
PN=1
Contents
01
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-2
PN=2
Group 000
Safety
Handle Fluids SafelyAvoid Fires
When you work around fuel, do not smoke or work near heaters or other fire hazards. Store flammable fluids away from fire hazards. Do not incinerate or puncture pressurized containers. Make sure machine is clean of trash, grease, and debris. Do not store oily rags; they can ignite and burn spontaneously.
01 000 1
DX,FLAME 1929SEP981/1
DX,FIRE3 1916APR921/1
Keep emergency numbers for doctors, ambulance service, hospital, and fire department near your telephone.
DX,FIRE2 1903MAR931/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-1
PN=9
TS291
TS1356
TS227
UN23AUG88
Safety
01 000 2
Avoid the hazard by relieving pressure before disconnecting hydraulic or other lines. Tighten all connections before applying pressure. Search for leaks with a piece of cardboard. Protect hands and body from high pressure fluids. If an accident occurs, see a doctor immediately. Any fluid injected into the skin must be surgically removed within a few hours or gangrene may result. Doctors unfamiliar with this type of injury should reference a knowledgeable medical source. Such information is available from Deere & Company Medical Department in Moline, Illinois, U.S.A.
DX,FLUID 1903MAR931/1
DX,WEAR 1910SEP901/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-2
PN=10
TS206
UN23AUG88
X9811
Safety
01 000 3
DX,LOOSE 1904JUN901/1
DX,AIR 1917FEB991/1
DX,CLEAN 1904JUN901/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-3
PN=11
T6642EJ
UN18OCT88
TS220
TS228
Safety
01 000 4
DX,PAINT 1919JUL011/1
DX,TORCH 1903MAR931/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-4
PN=12
TS953
UN15MAY90
TS220
Safety
01 000 5
DX,LIGHT 1904JUN901/1
DX,SAFE,TOOLS 1910OCT971/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-5
PN=13
LX1016749
TS223
UN23AUG88
Safety
01 000 6
DX,SERV 1917FEB991/1
DX,REPAIR 1917FEB991/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-6
PN=14
TS779
UN08NOV89
TS218
UN23AUG88
Safety
01 000 7
DX,DRAIN 1903MAR931/1
DX,LIVE 1925SEP921/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-7
PN=15
TS231
TS1133
Safety
01 000 8
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-000-8
PN=16
Group 001
Engine Identification
Engine Model Designation
John Deere Engine Model4045 and 6068 Engines John Deere engine model designation includes number of cylinders, displacement in liters, aspiration, user code, and application code. For example:
4045TF275 Engine 4 ................................................................ 4.5 ............................................................. T ............................................................... F ............................................................... 275 ............................................................ Aspiration Code D ............................................................... T ............................................................... A ............................................................... H ............................................................... User Factory Code AT ............................................................. CQ ............................................................ DW ............................................................ E ............................................................... F ............................................................... FF ............................................................. FG ............................................................. FM ............................................................ H ............................................................... KV ............................................................. L ................................................................ LA ............................................................. LV ............................................................. N ............................................................... P ............................................................... PY ............................................................. RW ............................................................ T ............................................................... T8 ............................................................. TJ .............................................................. YC ............................................................. Z ............................................................... Application Code 001, etc. .................................................... Number of cylinders Liter displacement Aspiration code User code POWERTECH application code Naturally aspirated Turbocharged, no aftercooling Turbocharged and Air-to-Coolant Aftercooled Turbocharged and Air-to-Air Aftercooled Agritalia srl (Vittoria, Sicily, Italy) John Deere Brazil (Horizontina, Brazil) John Deere Davenport Works (Davenport, Iowa) John Deere Ottumwa Works (Ottumwa, Iowa) OEM (Outside Equipment Manufacturers) Deere-Hitachi (Kernersville, North Carolina) Goldoni S.P.A. (Modena, Italy) Marine Engines John Deere Harvester Works (East Moline, Illinois) John Deere Commercial Worksite Products (Knoxville, Tennessee) John Deere Werke Mannheim (Germany) John Deere Werke Mannheim (Germany) (Engines with Bosch VP44 Injection Pump) John Deere Commercial Products (Augusta, Georgia) John Deere Des Moines Works (Des Moines, Iowa) Industrias John Deere Mexico S.A. de C.V. (Saltillo/Monterrey, Mexico) Larson & Toubro Ltd. (Pune, India) John Deere Waterloo Tractor Works (Waterloo, Iowa) John Deere Dubuque Works (Dubuque, Iowa) Cameco Industries (Thibodaux, Louisiana) Timberjack (Deere) (Sweden/Finland/Canada) John Deere Jialian Harvester Co. Limited (China) John Deere WERKE Zweibrucken (Germany) See ENGINE APPLICATION CHARTS, later in this Group 01 001 1
OUO1080,00001FA 1915NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-001-1
PN=17
Engine Identification
01 001 2
Engine Application Data (C) The second line of information on the serial number plate identifies the engine/machine or OEM relationship. See ENGINE APPLICATION CHARTS later in this group. Coefficient of Absorption (D) (Saran-Built Engines Only) The second line of information on the Saran serial number plate also contains the coefficient of absorption value for smoke emissions.
OUO1080,00001FB 1915NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-001-2
PN=18
RG11948
UN06NOV01
RG11949
UN07NOV01
RG9060
UN16MAR98
RG11816
Engine Identification
01 001 3
NOTE: Before hot tank cleaning, ensure that option codes are recorded elsewhere.
OUO1080,000020E 1926NOV011/1
OUO1080,0000035 1929AUG011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-001-3
PN=19
RG12027
Engine Identification
01 001 4
OUO1089,0000205 1909NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-001-4
PN=20
Group 002
Fuels
Lubricants and Coolant
NOTE: Refer to Section 01, Group 002 of CTM104 Base Engine Manual for information on lubricants and coolants.
01 002 1
DPSG,OUO1004,2761 1916MAY001/1
Diesel Fuel
Consult your local fuel distributor for properties of the diesel fuel available in your area. In general, diesel fuels are blended to satisfy the low temperature requirements of the geographical area in which they are marketed. Diesel fuels specified to EN 590 or ASTM D975 are recommended. Required fuel properties In all cases, the fuel must meet the following properties: Cetane number of 45 minimum. Cetane number greater than 50 is preferred, especially for temperatures below -20C (-4F) or elevations above 1500 m (5000 ft). Cold Filter Plugging Point (CFPP) below the expected low temperature OR Cloud Point at least 5C (9F) below the expected low temperature. Fuel lubricity should pass a minimum load level of 3100 grams as measured by ASTM D6078 or, maximum scar diameter of 0.45 mm as measured by ASTM D6079. Sulfur content: Diesel fuel quality and fuel sulfur content must comply with all existing regulations for the area in which the engine operates. Sulfur content less than 0.05% (500 ppm) is preferred. If diesel fuel with sulfur content greater than 0.05% (500 ppm) is used, crankcse oil service intervals may be affected. (See recommendation for Diesel Engine Oil.) DO NOT use diesel fuel with sulfur content greater than 1.0%. IMPORTANT: DO NOT mix used engine oil or any other type of lubricating oil with diesel fuel.
OUOD002,0000171 1918DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-002-1
PN=21
Fuels
01 002 2
Bio-Diesel Fuel
Consult your local fuel distributor for properties of the bio-diesel fuel available in your area. Bio-diesel fuels may be used ONLY if the bio-diesel fuel properties meet the latest edition of ASTM PS121, DIN 51606 or equivalent specification. It has been found that bio-diesel fuels may improve lubricity in concentrations up to a 5% blend in petroleum diesel fuel. When using a blend of bio-diesel fuel, the engine oil level must be checked daily when the air temperature is -10C (14F) or lower. If the oil becomes diluted with fuel, shorten oil change intervals accordingly. IMPORTANT: Raw pressed vegetable oils are NOT acceptable for use for fuel in any concentration in John Deere engines. These oils do not burn completely, and will cause engine failure by leaving deposits on injectors and in the combustion chamber. A major environmental benefit of bio-diesel fuel is its ability to biodegrade. This makes proper storage and handling of bio-diesel fuel especially important. Areas of concern include: Quality of new fuel Water content of the fuel Problems due to aging of the fuel Potential problems resulting from deficiencies in the above areas when using bio-diesel fuel in concentrations above 5% may lead to the following symptoms: Power loss and deterioration of performance Fuel leakage Corrosion of fuel injection equipment Coked and/or blocked injector nozzles, resulting in engine misfire Filter plugging Lacquering and/or seizure of internal components Sludge and sediments Reduced service life of engine components
RG41183,0000046 1918DEC011/1
DX,FUEL6 1906DEC001/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-002-2
PN=22
Fuels
01 002 3
OUOD002,0000179 1918DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-002-3
PN=23
Fuels
01 002 4
CTM331 (09APR02)
01-002-4
PN=24
Section 02
Group 090Electronic Fuel System Repair and Adjustments Fuel SystemGeneral Information . . . . . . . . .02-090-1 Relieve Fuel System Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-1 Remove and Install Final Fuel Filter/Water Bowl and/or Pre-Filter/Water Bowl Base . . .02-090-2 Fuel Pre-Filter/Water Bowl Assembly (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-5 Final Fuel Filter Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-6 Replace Final Fuel Filter/Water Bowl and Pre-Filter/Water Bowl. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-7 Remove Fuel Supply Pump. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-9 Install Fuel Supply Pump. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-10 Injection Pump Static Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-10 Remove Injection Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-11 Inspect Injection Pump Drive Gear ID and Shaft OD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-13 Install Injection Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-13 Remove Fuel Injection Nozzles . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-16 Clean Fuel Injection Nozzle Bore . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Clean Fuel Injection Nozzles . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Fuel Injection Nozzle Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-19 Disassemble Fuel Injection Nozzles . . . . . . .02-090-22 Adjust Fuel Injection Nozzle . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-23 Install Seals on Fuel Injection Nozzle . . . . . .02-090-24 Install Fuel Injection Nozzles . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-25 Bleed the Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-26 Group 110Electrical Engine Control Repair and Adjustment Engine Control Unit (ECU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-1 Remove and Install Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Remove and Install Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Replace Crankshaft Position Sensor . . . . . . . .02-110-3 Remove and Install Oil Pressure Sensor . . . . .02-110-3 Remove and Install Manifold Air Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 Remove and Install Fuel Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 Remove and Install Fuel Heater . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-5 Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-6 Use Electrical Insulating Compound . . . . . . . .02-110-6 Using High-Pressure Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-7 Repair WEATHERPACK Connector . . . . . . .02-110-8 CTM331 (09APR02)
Remove Blade Terminals from Connector Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-11 Repair (Pull Type) METRI-PACK Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-12 Repair (Push Type) METRI-PACK Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-14 Repair DEUTSCH Connectors . . . . . . . . . .02-110-17 Repair AMP Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-20
02-1
PN=1
Contents
02
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-2
PN=2
Group 090
02 090 1
OUO1089,00001F7 1906NOV011/1
RG,35,JW7625 1920NOV971/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-1
PN=27
X9811
UN23AUG88
Remove and Install Final Fuel Filter/Water Bowl and/or Pre-Filter/Water Bowl Base
Refer to operators manual for proper servicing and (hourly) replacement intervals. Engines are equipped with a final fuel filter/water bowl (A) and may have an optional pre-filter/water bowl. Final fuel filters/water bowls can be equipped with a transparent (see-through) water collection bowl and/or hand primer on machines equipped with only one filter.
AFinal Fuel Filter/Water Bowl
UN15NOV01
02 090 2
OUO1089,00001F6 1906NOV011/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-2
PN=28
RG11989
NOTE: The fuel filters are keyed to the filter header. If both pre-filter and final filter are removed, ensure that they are reinstalled in the correct headers.
3. Remove final fuel filter element and pre-filter/water bowl, if desired. See REPLACE FINAL FUEL FILTER/WATER BOWL AND PRE-FILTER/WATER BOWL, in this group.
Final Fuel Filter Base
NOTE: Pre-filter and final filter fuel lines may be connected to different filter inlet and outlet ports depending on engine application. Mark fuel line location to aid during assembly. Refer to markings on fuel filter base for fuel inlet/outlet ports, as they are different between the pre- and final filter bases.
4. Disconnect fuel lines from all ports. 5. Remove final fuel filter base (A). 6. If equipped, remove pre-filter base. 7. Replace parts as necessary. 8. Install mounting brackets and tighten to torque specifications provided below.
Specification Final Fuel Filter Bracket-to-Cylinder Head Torque ............................................................................. Final Fuel Filter Mounting Base-to-BracketTorque ................................................ Fuel Pre-Filter Bracket-to-Cylinder Head and AlternatorTorque ......................................... Fuel Pre-Filter/Water Bowl Mounting Base-to-Bracket Torque .............................................................................
50 Nm (36 lb-ft)
OUO1089,00001F6 1906NOV012/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-3
PN=29
RG12021
10. Connect fuel lines to all ports. 11. Bleed the fuel system. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM in this group.
OUO1089,00001F6 1906NOV013/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-4
PN=30
02 090 5
RG,35,JW7623 1921JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-5
PN=31
RGT7751HS
UN19NOV97
RGT7751HR
UN19NOV97
02 090 6
OUO1080,00001FC 1915NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-6
PN=32
RG12015
UN16NOV01
02 090 7
UN15NOV01
NOTE: Lifting up on retaining ring (A) as it is rotated helps to get it past raised locators.
3. Firmly grasp the retaining ring (A) and rotate it counterclockwise 1/4 turn. Remove ring with filter element (B). 4. Inspect filter mounting base for cleanliness. Clean as required. 5. Remove transparent (see-through) water bowl, if equipped. Drain and clean water bowl. Dry with compressed air. 6. Install transparent (see-through) water bowl, if equipped, onto new filter element. Make sure O-ring is properly installed in the top groove of bowl. 7. Thoroughly inspect filter base dust seal ring. Replace as needed.
OUO1089,00001F5 1906NOV011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-7
PN=33
RG11990
Electronic Fuel System Repair and Adjustments NOTE: The fuel filters must be indexed properly and the key on canister must be oriented in slot of mounting base for correct installation.
02 090 8
8. Install new filter element onto mounting base and position element using a slight rocking motion. Be sure element is properly indexed on mounting base. 9. Install retaining ring onto mounting base and tighten about 1/3 turn until ring snaps into the detent. DO NOT overtighten the retaining ring. 10. Bleed fuel system. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM, in this group.
OUO1089,00001F5 1906NOV012/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-8
PN=34
02 090 9
UN15NOV01
NOTE: The fuel supply pump is driven by a push rod (D) that rides on an eccentric camshaft lobe. The cylinder head must be removed to remove this push rod.
3. Cover opening on cylinder block to prevent dirt from entering the engine.
ASupply Pump Inlet from Fuel Tank BSupply Pump Outlet to Final Fuel Filter CCap Screws DPush Rod
RG9051
UN16MAR98
4. Inspect face of pump lever for wear. If lever face is worn flat or concave, replace pump.
OUO1089,00001F8 1906NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-9
PN=35
RG12022
UN27NOV01
RG11991
02 090 10
1. Install the fuel supply pump to cylinder block with pumping lever resting on top of push rod, using a new O-ring. Tighten cap screws (C) to specifications.
Specification Fuel Supply Pump Cap Screws Torque ............................................................................. 30 Nm (22 lb-ft)
IMPORTANT: ALWAYS use a backup wrench when installing fittings and/or fuel lines onto supply pump to avoid damage to fittings. 2. Connect supply pump inlet line (A) and outlet line (B) and tighten securely. 3. Bleed fuel system. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM in this group.
OUO1089,00001FA 1906NOV011/1
OUO1089,00001FB 1906NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-10
PN=36
RG11991
02 090 11
OUO1089,00001FE 1907NOV011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-11
PN=37
RG12000
UN21JAN02
RG12036
RG12002
02 090 12
9. Disconnect fuel supply line (D) and return line (C). 10. Remove clamp (E) retaining fuel delivery (pressure) lines (F). 11. Disconnect all fuel delivery lines (F) from injection pump and install protective caps. 12. Remove three injection pump mounting stud nuts (G). Remove injection pump from mounting studs. Place pump on a clean flat surface and inspect shaft OD and drive gear as outlined later in this group. See INSPECT INJECTION PUMP DRIVE GEAR ID AND SHAFT OD later in this group.
ATemperature Sensor Connector BFuel Control Solenoid Connector CFuel Return Line DFuel Supply Line EClamp FFuel Delivery Lines GNut (3 used)
OUO1089,00001FE 1907NOV012/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-12
PN=38
RG12003
UN16NOV01
RG12001
02 090 13
OUO1089,00001FC 1906NOV011/1
OUO1089,0000204 1908NOV011/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-13
PN=39
RG12019
UN19NOV01
Electronic Fuel System Repair and Adjustments NOTE: When rotating engine to TDC of compression stroke on number 1 cylinder, turn engine only in direction of rotation to prevent gear backlash. Backlash of gears is enough to throw the injection pump timing off by several degrees, resulting in poor engine performance.
2. Make sure that number 1 cylinder is locked at TDC of compression stroke and install JDG1571 Timing Pin in flywheel.
02 090 14
3. Install injection pump onto mounting studs and tighten three pump mounting stud nuts (A) to specification. Position drive gear while installing pump.
Specification Injection Pump Mounting Stud NutsTorque .................................................................. 25 Nm (19 lb-ft)
4. Install injection pump gear (D) on drive shaft. Install, but do not tighten, injection pump gear mounting nut (C).
NOTE: Hold the injection pump gear while applying torque to prevent the gear from rotating.
5. Rotate gear counterclockwise (viewed from front of engine) to remove any backlash, and tighten gear mounting nut to specification.
Injection Pump Timing Pin
Specification Injection Pump Gear Mounting NutTorque ................................................................ 195 Nm (145 lb-ft)
6. Install injection pump gear access plate and remove timing pin (B) from pump. Install plug in injection pump timing pin hole and tighten to specification.
Specification Injection Pump Timing Pin Plug Torque ........................................................................... 9.5 Nm (7.5 lb-ft)
UN16NOV01
OUO1089,0000204 1908NOV012/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-14
RG12008
PN=40
RG12007
UN16NOV01
RG12004
UN16NOV01
02 090 15
10. Install clamp (E). 11. Connect fuel supply line (D) and fuel return line (C). 12. Install temperature sensor connector (A) and fuel control solenoid connector (B). 13. Bleed air from fuel system as outlined in this group. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM in this group. Start engine, run for several minutes and check entire fuel system for leaks.
ATemperature Sensor Connector BFuel Control Solenoid Connector CFuel Return Line DFuel Supply Line EClamp FFuel Delivery Lines GNut (3 used) HEngine Block Side IOutlet Connection to No. 1 Cylinder
OUO1089,0000204 1908NOV013/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-15
PN=41
RG12035
UN11JAN02
RG12003
UN16NOV01
RG12001
UN16NOV01
Immediately fit protective caps over the nozzle tips and the line connections to avoid handling damage and getting debris in fuel system. Do not bend the fuel delivery lines, as this may affect their durability. When loosening the fuel pressure lines, hold male union of nozzle line stationary with a backup wrench.
OUO1089,00001FF 1907NOV011/4
1. Loosen tube nuts (A) at each nozzle to remove leak-off lines and T-fittings as an assembly.
ATube Nuts
OUO1089,00001FF 1907NOV012/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-16
PN=42
RG11994
UN15NOV01
RG11993
Before removal, thoroughly remove all dirt from the cylinder head around fuel injection nozzles. Clean with compressed air to prevent dirt from entering the cylinders. Plug the bore in the cylinder head after each nozzle has been removed. Cap fuel line openings as soon as they are disconnected.
UN15NOV01
02 090 17
OUO1089,00001FF 1907NOV013/4
4. Pull injection nozzle out of cylinder head using JDG1515-1 Nozzle Puller (A). IMPORTANT: Do not use screwdrivers, pry bars, or similar tools for this as they might damage the injection nozzle beyond repair.
AJDG1515-1 Nozzle Puller
UN16NOV01
OUO1089,00001FF 1907NOV014/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-17
PN=43
RG12018
RG11999
02 090 18
RG,35,JW7596 1920NOV971/1
RG7743
OUO1080,00001FD 1915NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-18
PN=44
RG11995
Use only carefully filtered diesel fuel for testing the injection nozzles, since dirty fuel will severely damage the precision parts of a nozzle.
Fuel Injection Nozzle Test
Connect the nozzle to the tester so that the axis of the nozzle forms an angle of approximately 30 to the vertical and the spray of fuel is directed downwards. Check all connections for leaks. Close the gauge shut-off valve and flush (bleed) the nozzle by operating test pump rapidly.
OUO1089,0000200 1907NOV011/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-19
PN=45
L30741
UN08AUG89
NOTE: Testing the performance of a nozzle while the engine is running is just a rough test. To obtain a true check of nozzle performance, use a nozzle tester JT25510 (1) and pressure line KJD10109 (2).
X9811
UN23AUG88
02 090 19
02 090 20
Checking Valve Seat Connect the nozzle to tester in horizontal position. Operate the pump lever rapidly to bleed the nozzle and allow the valve to seat. Dry the tip of the nozzle thoroughly. Now operate the pump lever slowly until the indicated pressure is approximately 2800 to 3500 kPa (28 to 35 bar) (400 to 500 psi) below opening pressure (see specification for opening pressure). Keep watching the nozzle. Under these conditions the fluid should not drip out of the nozzle tip. However some weeping or light moisture on the tip is considered acceptable. Work the pump lever quickly several times in succession to make the nozzle spray in the normal way. After the last stroke of the pump, observe again. If the nozzle is not quite leakproof, disassemble for servicing.
OUO1089,0000200 1907NOV012/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-20
PN=46
NOTE: Absolute opening pressure is less important than equal opening pressure of all nozzles.
Close gauge shut-off valve and actuate the pump several times to allow the nozzle valve to seat properly. Open gauge shut-off valve. Pump the pressure up to the point where the pressure gauge needle falls rapidly. This point (take reading) is the nozzle valve opening pressure.
Fuel Injection NozzleSpecification Rate Shaping NozzleOpening Pressure for Setting (New or Reconditioned)............................................. 24 40024 900 kPa (244249 bar) (35403620 psi) Opening Pressure for Checking (New or Reconditioned).......................... 24 100 kPa (241 bar) (3500 psi) Min Opening Pressure for Setting (Used) ........................................................................ 23 00023 600 kPa (230236 bar) (33403420 psi) Opening Pressure for Checking (Used) ..................................................... 21 800 kPa (218 bar) (3170 psi) Min Rate Shaping NozzleOpening pressure difference between cylinders..................................................... 700 kPa (7 bar) (100 psi) Max 02 090 21
If spray pattern, leakage test, and valve wear test are good but the opening pressure test is unsatisfactory, adjust opening pressure.
OUO1089,0000200 1907NOV013/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-21
PN=47
02 090 22
OUO1089,0000201 1907NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-22
PN=48
RG11996
OUO1089,0000202 1907NOV011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-23
PN=49
RG11997
X9811
UN23AUG88
02 090 23
02 090 24
OUO1089,0000202 1907NOV012/2
NOTE: If nozzle is not going to be installed at this time, install a No. 16189 Nozzle Protector Cap over nozzle tip. Plug all other openings in nozzle to prevent contamination.
RG,35,JW7586 1920NOV971/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-24
PN=50
RG9096
UN27MAR98
NOTE: If nozzle bore in cylinder head must be cleaned, use JDE39 Nozzle Bore Cleaning Tool. See REMOVE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES earlier in this group.
1. Remove plug (if installed previously) from nozzle bore in cylinder head and blow out bore with compressed air.
UN19NOV01
02 090 25
NOTE: Make sure that the sealing surface of the cylinder head (on which the seal washer will be resting) is smooth and free of damage or dirt. This could prevent proper sealing. Dirt and roughness could also cause nozzle to be distorted when the attaching screw is tightened, making the valve stick.
2. Install nozzle with spacer and clamps in cylinder head using a slight twisting motion as nozzle is seated in bore. Illustration shows relationship of parts required for proper installation. 3. Align nozzle clamps and install cap screw. Do not tighten cap screw at this stage. 4. Connect fuel pressure line to nozzle. Leave connection slightly loose until air is bled from system. 5. Tighten nozzle hold-down clamp cap screws to specifications.
Specification Fuel Injection Nozzle Hold-Down Clamp Cap ScrewsTorque........................................... 40 Nm (30 lb-ft)
OUO1080,0000200 1916NOV011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-25
PN=51
RG11998
OUO1080,0000200 1916NOV012/2
OUO1089,0000203 1907NOV011/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-26
PN=52
X9811
UN23AUG88
RG11999
UN19NOV01
02 090 27
OUO1089,0000203 1907NOV012/5
2. Operate fuel supply pump prime lever (B) or primer button on fuel filter base (if equipped). 3. Tighten bleed plug securely; continue operating primer until pumping action is not felt. 4. Start engine and check for leaks. If engine will not start, it may be necessary to bleed air from fuel system at fuel injection pump or injection nozzles as explained next.
BPrimer Lever
UN25OCT01
OUO1089,0000203 1907NOV013/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-27
PN=53
RG11806
RG11805
OUO1089,0000203 1907NOV014/5
At Fuel Injection Nozzles 1. Place throttle lever in half-throttle position. IMPORTANT: Always use a backup wrench when loosening or tightening fuel lines at nozzles and/or injection pump to avoid damage. 2. Using two open-end wrenches, loosen two fuel line connections at injection nozzles. 3. Crank engine over with starter motor for 15 seconds (but do not start engine) until fuel without any air bubbles flows out of loosened connection. Retighten connection to specifications.
Specification Fuel Injection Nozzle Delivery LinesTorque ................................................................. 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
4. Repeat procedure for remaining injection nozzles (if necessary) until all air has been removed from fuel system. If engine still will not start, see your authorized servicing dealer or engine distributor.
OUO1089,0000203 1907NOV015/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-090-28
PN=54
RG11808
UN25OCT01
RG11807
3. As soon as fuel flow is free from air bubbles, tighten fuel return line to specifications. Primer lever is spring-loaded and will return to normal position.
UN25OCT01
2. Operate fuel supply pump primer lever or primer button on fuel filter base (if equipped).
Group 110
02 110 1
NOTE: For diagnosis and testing of the electronic engine control and sensors, refer to Group 150.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT OPEN ENGINE CONTROL UNIT.
NOTE: The sealed ECU assembly is the system component LEAST likely to fail. Ensure that it is isolated and identified as the defective component before replacing. See operation and test manual for proper troubleshooting procedures.
The ECU is not repairable. If it is found to be defective, replace it as a unit. Provide the 13-digit engine serial number when ordering a new ECU. IMPORTANT: If an ECU is not programmed identically with the original (failed) ECU, misleading diagnostic messages, poor performance, or engine damage can occur.
OUO1080,0000201 1916NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-1
PN=55
RG12006
02 110 2
OUO1080,0000202 1916NOV011/1
RG40854,000014A 1911FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-2
RG10766
PN=56
RG12009
UN16NOV01
OUO1080,0000203 1916NOV011/1
LOCTITE is a registered trademark of Loctite Corp. TEFLON is a registered trademark of Du Pont Co.
OUO1080,0000204 1916NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-3
PN=57
RG10550
RG12011
02 110 4
OUO1080,00001F5 1909NOV011/1
OUO1080,00001F6 1912NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-4
PN=58
RG12014
RG12013
2. Replace O-ring and install fuel heater in primary fuel filter inlet port to specifications.
Specification Fuel HeaterTorque ........................................................... 9 Nm (7 lb-ft)
02 110 5
OUO1080,00001F7 1912NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-5
PN=59
RG12016
Connectors
Connectors are devices that provide for assembly and disassembly of systems. Connectors should always be serviced using tools designed for that type of connector. A good crimp is important to mechanical and electrical soundness. Repaired connectors should be physically tested by pulling to be sure the contact is firmly attached to the conductor. IMPORTANT: If for some reason the connectors are not connected, such as when the fuel injection pump is removed, it is important to protect the connectors from debris. Refer to the procedures which follow for repair of various types of connectors.
02 110 6
RG,RG34710,1328 1923OCT971/1
RG,RG34710,1335 1923OCT971/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-6
PN=60
RG,RG34710,1329 1923OCT971/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-7
PN=61
T6642EJ
UN18OCT88
02 110 7
02 110 8
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-8
PN=62
TS0128
IMPORTANT: The seal must fit snug over the cable insulation without a gap between the cable seal and the insulation.
02 110 9
Green - 1820 Gauge Wire Gray - 1416 Gauge Wire Blue - 1012 Gauge Wire
AG,OUOD008,296 1906MAR022/4
8. Select correct size terminal on wire and crimp in position with a W-type crimp using a JDG783 WEATHER PACK Crimping Tool.
AG,OUOD008,296 1906MAR023/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-9
PN=63
TS1623
TS0136
NOTE: Cable seals are color coded for three sizes of wire:
NOTE: Connector bodies are keyed for correct terminals. Be sure terminals are correctly aligned. Correct terminal installation for sleeve (A) and pin (B) is illustrated.
10. Gently pull on wire to insure that the terminal is locked in position. 11. Repair or transfer remaining wires. 12. Close the secondary lock on the back of the connector. 13. Retape wires and add the required tie bands to the harness.
ASleeve BPin
AG,OUOD008,296 1906MAR024/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-10
PN=64
TS0139
UN02DEC88
TS0130
UN23AUG88
IMPORTANT: Terminal tangs must be carefully spread to ensure good seating on connector body. If terminal is being reused in a new connector, make sure tangs are spread.
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-11
PN=65
RW4218
UN23AUG88
02 110 11
02 110 12
2. Remove tie bands and tape from the wiring harness behind the connector. 3. Identify wire color/number to the connector cavity. Make sure each wire goes back to the correct cavity location. 4. Using JDG776 Terminal Extraction Tool (C)1, carefully remove the connector seal (B) from the back of the connector. IMPORTANT: Make sure no damage to the seal occurs or water and contaminants will corrode terminals.
NOTE: Extraction tool must be used from the back of the connector.
5. Using JDG776 Terminal Extraction Tool (C), angle the tip so it slides along the top edge of the connector. Make sure the extraction tool is centered in the connector cavity and push the tool in until resistance is felt. 6. With extraction tool inserted into the connector, gently rotate tool clockwise and counter-clockwise (no more than 1/8 turn each direction) to depress the terminal locking tang (D). 7. Remove extraction tool from back of connector. 8. Push wire until terminal has extracted from the front of the connector. If terminal does not extract, repeat steps 4-6.
AConnector BConnector Seal CJDG777 Terminal Extraction Tool DTerminal Locking Tang ETerminal
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-12
PN=66
RW16935A
UN05AUG98
NOTE: Terminal will seat only one way. If terminal does not pull into the connector body socket, check for correct terminal alignment (E).
14. Push on the wire to make sure terminal is locked into the connector. 15. Slide the connector seal back into the connector. Make sure seal is in its origional position. 16. Retape the wires and add the required tie bands to the harness.
RG12233A
RG12234A
UN13MAR02
02 110 13
DTerminal Locking Tang ECorrect Terminal Orientation FWire GJDG783 Terminal Crimping Tool HJDG707 Terminal Crimping Tool
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-13
PN=67
RW16935A
UN05AUG98
02 110 14
6. Using JDG145 Universal Electrical Pliers2, cut off wire directly behind the terminal. 7. Using JDG145 Universal Electrical Pliers2 strip 6 mm (1/4 in.) insulation from end of wire. 8. Select correct size of seal. Slide the seal over the wire insulation with the smaller diameter side facing the end of the wire. Small diameter side of seal should line up with the outer edge of the insulation.
Included in JT07195B Electrical Repair Kit Included in JDG155 Electrical Repair Tool Kit
Continued on next page AG,OUOD008,299 1906MAR021/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-14
PN=68
TS0136
5. Remove extraction tool and pull wire from the back of the connector.
UN23AUG88
NOTE: Use JDG776 Extraction Tool with 56, 280, and 630 Series METRI-PACK terminals. Use JDG777 Extraction Tool with 150 Series METRI-PACK terminals.
RW77137
NOTE: Cable seals are color coded for three sizes of wire:
Green - 1820 Gauge Wire Gray - 1416 Gauge Wire Blue - 1012 Gauge Wire 9. Select correct size contact for wire.
02 110 15
AG,OUOD008,299 1906MAR022/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-15
PN=69
02 110 16
AG,OUOD008,299 1906MAR023/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-16
PN=70
RW77140A
UN15MAR02
RW77138A
UN15MAR02
RW77139
2. Identify wire color/number to the connector cavity. Make sure each wire goes back to the correct cavity location. 3. Select correct size extractor tool for size of wire to be removed: JDG361 JDG362 JDG363 JDG785 Extractor Extractor Extractor Extractor Tool Tool Tool Tool 1214 Gauge Wire1 1618 Gauge Wire1 20 Gauge Wire2 6-8 Gauge Wire3
02 110 17
AHandle
4. Start inserting the wire into the handle end (A) of the correct size extraction tool. 5. Slide extraction tool rearward along wire until tool tip snaps onto wire. IMPORTANT: DO NOT twist tool when inserting in connector. 6. Slide extraction tool along wire into connector body until tool is positioned over terminal contact. 7. Pull wire from connector body using extraction tool. 8. Using JDG145 Universal Electrical Pliers4 cut off wire directly behind the terminal. 9. Using JDG145 Universal Electrical Pliers4, strip 6 mm (1/4 in.) insulation from end of wire.
Included in JDG359 DEUTSCH Electrical Repair Kit Included in JT07195B Electrical Repair Tool Kit Included in JDG155 Electrical Repair Tool Kit
AG,OUOD008,304 1903NOV991/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-17
PN=71
RW77142
02 110 18
12. Insert terminal (A) and turn adjusting screw (D) until terminal is flush with cover (B). IMPORTANT: Select correct size terminal to fit connector body. 13. Tighten lock nut (C).
ATerminal BCover CLock Nut DAdjusting Screw
UN23AUG88
AG,OUOD008,304 1903NOV993/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-18
PN=72
TS0134
TS117
02 110 19
17. Push terminal straight into correct connector cavity until positive stop is felt. IMPORTANT: Install terminal in correct connector cavity using correct size grommet. 18. Gently pull on wire to verify terminal is locked into the connector. 19. Transfer remaining wires to correct cavity in new connector.
AG,OUOD008,304 1903NOV994/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-19
PN=73
RW77141
UN07DEC98
20. Retape the wires and add the required tie bands to the harness.
TS0135
TS118
02 110 20
1. Disconnect AMP connector. Remove the tie bands and tape. 2. Identify wire color/number to the connector cavity. Make sure the each wire goes back into the correct cavity location. 3. Press JDG1369 Terminal Extraction Tool into face of connector and remove wire and terminal from back of connector.
6. Holding the terminal (F) by the mating end, insert the insulation barrel (G) first, through the front of the tool and into the appropriate crimp slot (D or E). IMPORTANT: Make sure that both sides of the insulation barrel (G) are started evenly into the crimping section. Do NOT attempt to crimp an improperly positioned terminal. 7. Position the terminal so that the open U of the wire and insulation barrels (H and G) face the top of the tool. Place the terminal up into the nest so that the movable locator (B) drops into the slot in the terminal as shown. Butt the front end of the wire barrel (H) against the movable locator. 8. Hold the terminal (F) in position and squeeze the tool handles together until ratchet engages sufficiently to hold the terminal in position. DO NOT deform insulation barrel or wire barrel. 9. Insert stripped wire (C) into terminal insulation and wire barrels until it is butted against the wire stop.
NOTE: Verify wire stripping length and crimp height before using AMP crimping tool. See instructions provided with tool.
4. Strip new wire to length indicated in tool instructions. Do not nick or cut wire strands. 5. Hold JDG708 AMP Crimping Tool so that the back (wire side) is facing you. Squeeze tool handles together and allow them to open fully.
NOTE: See instructions provided with tool to determine which crimping slot (D or E) to use.
DPSG,OUO1004,2867 1906MAR021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-20
PN=74
RG10742
UN31MAY00
NOTE: The crimped terminal may stick in the crimping area. It can be easily removed by pushing downward on the top of the locator (B).
11. Install wire in correct connector cavity. 12. Retape the wires and add the required tie bands to the harness.
AWire and Terminal BLocator
02 110 21
DPSG,OUO1004,2867 1906MAR022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-21
PN=75
T112335E
UN15MAR02
02 110 22
CTM331 (09APR02)
02-110-22
PN=76
Section 03
Theory of Operation
Contents
Page
Group 130Electronic Fuel System Operation About this Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-1 Fuel System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-2 Fuel Supply Pump Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-4 Final Fuel Filter Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-5 Fuel Injection Pump Operation . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-6 Fuel Injection Nozzle Operation. . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-8 Group 140Electronic Control System Operation About This Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-1 Electronic Control System Terminology . . . . . .03-140-2 Electronic Control System Operation . . . . . . . .03-140-3 Monitoring Engine Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-3 Electronic Control System Overview . . . . . . . .03-140-4 Measuring Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-5 Measuring Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-7 Measuring Throttle Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Measuring Engine Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Pump Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Engine Control Unit (ECU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-10 Controller Area Network (CAN) . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-11 Cruise Control Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Intake Air Heater Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Engine Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Derate Programs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Multiple Torque Curve Selection . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14 Governor Droop Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14 Engine Control Unit (ECU) Self-Diagnosis. . .03-140-15
03
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-1
PN=1
Contents
03
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-2
PN=2
Group 130
RG40854,000001C 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-1
PN=79
03 130 2
HFuel Leak-off Line ITank Pressure Fuel JSupply Pump Pressure Fuel
The fuel supply pump (C) draws fuel from the tank (A) by pressurizing the fuel. Once the fuel is pressurized in the fuel supply pump, it travels through the final fuel filter (D) to the fuel injection pump (E). On some
applications, fuel is routed through a prefilter (B) prior to the fuel supply pump. A water bowl can be included with either the prefilter or final fuel filters. Typically, the water bowl is located at the first filter in the system.
RG40854,000001D 1903DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-2
PN=80
RG11957
UN21DEC01
otu a small orifice in the nozzle tip. This allows for fuel to atomize as it enters the combustion chamber. Excess fuel from the nozzles is routed through the fuel return leak-off line and returns to the fuel tank. On some applications, the fuel goes through a fuel cooler before returning to the fuel tank.
RG40854,000001D 1903DEC012/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-3
PN=81
03 130 4
AFuel Outlet BOutlet Check Valve CInlet Check Valve DFuel Inlet EReturn Spring FRod GLever HHand Primer Lever IDiaphragm
RG40854,0000110 1916JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-4
PN=82
RG9119
03 130 5
RG40854,0000111 1916JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-5
PN=83
RG9090
UN27MAR98
03 130 6
NOTE: The above illustration has been reprinted with permission from Stanadyne Automotive Corporation.
The main components of the Stanadyne DE10 fuel injection pump are the driveshaft (B), the transfer pump (C), cam ring (D) and shoes, distributor rotor (H), pump control valve (G), and fuel control solenoid (F). The crankshaft of the engine drives the driveshaft of the pump using gears between the two components. The rotation of the driveshaft moves the transfer pump, cam shoes and rollers, and distributor shaft since all of these components are engaged. The fuel transfer pump (inside the injection pump) draws fuel from the final filter through the fuel inlet fitting (A). With each revolution, it pressurizes fuel between 01100 kPa (011 bar) (0160 psi) depending on the rotational speed of the pump. Once
the fuel has been pressurized by the transfer pump, it can travel to three locations: inside the plungers of the cam ring (D), into the injection pump housing cavaties, and recirculated back to the fuel inlet passage. When the pump control valve is open, it allows the transfer pump pressurized fuel to enter the high pressure chamber. The Engine Control Unit (ECU) energizes the fuel control solenoid which causes the pump control valve to close. When the pump control valve is closed, the plungers in the high pressure chamber create injection pressure because they are forced inward by the rotation of the cam ring. High pressure fuel is forced through the discharge fittings to the injection nozzles. When the fuel control solenoid is deenergized, the pump control valve opens. The fuel in the high pressure chamber is spilled out of the high pressure chamber into the transfer pump fuel.
RG40854,0000112 1916JAN021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-6
PN=84
RG11958
UN20DEC01
RG40854,0000112 1916JAN022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-7
PN=85
03 130 8
The carbon stop seal (B) prevents carbon from collecting around nozzle in cylinder head. The fuel injection nozzles have four orifices.
ASpray tip BCarbon stop seal CNozzle valve DNozzle body ESeal washer FConnection for injection line GNozzle valve guide HUnion nut ISpring seat JAdjustable pressure spring KLift adjusting screw LLock nut for pressure adjusting screw MT-fitting NLock nut for lift adjusting screw OPressure adjusting screw PLocation clamp QNipple RFilter screen SFuel pressure line TCap
RG40854,0000020 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-130-8
PN=86
RG11959
Group 140
03 140 1
RG40854,0000021 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-1
PN=87
DTC 03 140 2
DST
Digital ECT
ECU
FMI
J1587/J1708
MAT
PDM PROM
PWM
RAM
SAE
Sensor SPN
RG40854,0000023 1903DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-2
PN=88
RG40854,0000023 1903DEC012/2
NOTE: If a wiring problem prevents the key ON signal from getting to the ECU, the engine will not start.
As soon as the ECU receives an input from the crankshaft position sensor that the engine is cranking, it will move the pump control valve to the pressure position, which will allow injection pressure to be developed. The fuel is delivered to all of the cylinders. To provide cold temperature enrichment, the amount of fuel injected is based on the temperature measured by
RG40854,0000022 1903DEC011/1
RG40854,0000026 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-3
PN=89
03 140 4
AOil Pressure Sensor BPump Control Solenoid CEngine Control Unit (ECU)
NOTE: Some of the components shown are optional and not used on all applications.
The electronic control system serves as an engine governor by controlling the pump control valve through a solenoid so that fuel is delivered according to a given set of engine conditions, in precise amounts, and at a precise time in relation to piston position. In order
to achieve this, the engine control system peforms the following funtions: Constantly monitors engine operating conditions Delivery an optimum amount of fuel for operating conditions Provides multiple control modes Performs self-diagnosis
RG40854,0000024 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-4
RG11960
UN18DEC01
PN=90
Measuring Temperature
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor, Loss of Coolant Temperature sensor, Manifold Air Temperature (MAT) sensor, and Fuel Temperature sensor are thermistors (temperature sensitive variable resistors). The sensors resistance goes down as the temperature that it is exposed to goes up (negative temperature coefficient). Higher temperatures result in lower voltages and lower temperatures result in higher voltages. The Engine Control Unit (ECU) sends 5 volts to the sensor, monitors the voltage drop across the sensor, and compares the voltage drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory in order to determine temperature. In addition to temperature sensors, some applications use temperature switches. The loss of coolant temperature switch is an example. Temperature switches close when a specific temperature is reached.
RG11819
UN17AUG01
03 140 5
RG40854,0000025 1903DEC011/5
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor On most applications, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is located in the thermostat housing (A). On other applications, it may be located at the rear of the cylinder head. The ECU monitors coolant temperature for: Engine protection purposes. For more information on engine protection and derate programs see, ENGINE PROTECTION or DERATE PROGRAMS later in this Group. Starting fuel quantity determination The ECU will adjust the amount of fuel delivered during start-up based on initial ECT readings. Idle speed determination In order to speed engine warm-up, the ECU will increase idle speed after start-up if a low coolant temperature is measured.
UN29JAN02
AECT Sensor
RG40854,0000025 1903DEC012/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-5
RG11963
PN=91
03 140 6
RG40854,0000025 1903DEC013/5
Manifold Air Temperature (MAT) Sensor The Manifold Air Temperature (MAT) sensor is located in the cross over tube (A) or in the intake manifold. The MAT sensor measures intake air temperature to help the ECU calculate the correct fueling and for cold starting. The ECU also monitors manifold air temperature for engine protection purposes. For more information on engine protection and derate programs, see ENGINE PROTECTION or DERATE PROGRAMS later in this Group. This sensor is optional and is not included on all applications.
AMAT Sensor
RG10766
RG40854,0000025 1903DEC014/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-6
PN=92
RG11964
UN29JAN02
UN29JAN02
RG40854,0000025 1903DEC015/5
Measuring Pressure
The systems pressure sensors are 3 wire variable resistors. As the pressure changes, sensor resistance changes. The ECU sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the sensor, monitors the voltage returning on the sensor signal wire, and compares the voltage drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory to determine pressure. In addition to pressure sensors, some applications use pressure switches. Pressure switches close when a specific pressure is reached.
RG40854,0000027 1903DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-7
RG11820
UN17AUG01
RG11962
03 140 7
PN=93
RG40854,0000027 1903DEC012/2
RG40854,0000031 1905DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-8
RG11961
UN29JAN02
PN=94
UN29JAN02
RG40854,0000028 1903DEC011/1
Pump Solenoid
Located on the end of the injection pump, the pump solenoid (A) controls the movement of the pump control valve. This controls the quantity of fuel delivered to the engine. When the Engine Control Unit (ECU) supplies no current to the solenoid, the valve does not move. Thus, the injection pump delivers no fuel. When the ECU supplies current to the solenoid, the pump control valve closes off the high injection chamber. This allows fuel to be delivered from the injection pump. The quantity of fuel is determined by various sensors in the control system and messages sent to the ECU.
RG11965
03 140 9
RG40854,0000115 1924JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-9
RG11966
UN29JAN02
PN=95
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3
C1 C2 C3 D1 D2 D3
E1 E2 E3
03 140 10
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3
H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
ECU Connector
The Engine Control Unit (ECU) is the brains of the Electronic Control System. The ECU is a self-contained unit containing electronic circuitry and computer software which together perform the following functions: Converts the electrical signals from the various sensors into digital signals Makes decisions of optimum fuel quantity and timing based on information from various sensors Limits maximum fuel for operation on multiple power curves Controls pump control valve solenoid for desired fuel delivery Provides all-speed governing Performs self diagnosis on the control system Stores trouble codes in memory
The ECU is composed of the following subsystems: Analog/Digital Converters This portion of the ECU converts the analog voltage signals from the various sensors into digital signals that the central processing unit can understand. Central Processing Unit (CPU) The central processing unit performs the mathematical computations and logical functions that are necessary in controlling injection fuel quantity and injection timing. The CPU controls the pump control solenoid for desired fuel quantity and timing. It also controls the self diagnostic system.
RG40854,0000029 1903DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-10
RG11967
1919DEC01
PN=96
03 140 11
RG40854,0000029 1903DEC012/2
RG40854,000002A 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-11
PN=97
03 140 12
On 12 volt ECUs, the engine speed can be set from two different locations. The primary location would normally be in the cab of the vehicle and is used to set a constant engine speed while the vehicle is being driven. The secondary cruise control is normally used in a location that provides PTO speed control and is used with the engine in neutral or out of gear. Both locations have the normal cruise control functions.
RG40854,000002B 1903DEC011/1
RG40854,000002C 1903DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-12
PN=98
Engine Protection
Engine protection is necessary to prevent damage to an engine. There are three different engine protection programs available in Engine Control Units (ECUs): No Protection The ECU does not have the software to derate or shut the engine down. It is the responsibility of the operator to react to warning light(s) on their application. Derating or shutting the engine down may be necessary depending on the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) that is set. Refer to the operators manual to identify this information for a given application. Engine Protection WITHOUT Shutdown The ECU has the capability to derate an engine. It is the responsibility of the operator to react to warning light(s) on their application to identify if it is necessary to shut the engine down. Refer to the operators manual to retrieve this information for a given application. Engine Protection with Shutdown The ECU will derate the engine for given DTCs. If a DTC that requires shutdown is set, the ECU will severely derate the engine and shut the engine down in 30 seconds. If the problem is corrected within the 30 second delay period, the power will increase at a particular rate until full power is reached. Shutdown Override Feature
NOTE: Holding the shutdown override switch continuously ON will not reset the 30 second timer.
The engine protection shutdowns can be overridden for 30 seconds at a time. This can be used to move a vehicle to a safe location. Each time the switch is pushed, the shutdown timer is reset to 30 seconds, and the engine will run in a derated power mode. See APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for engine protection features on different sensors on your application.
03 140 13
RG40854,000002D 1904DEC011/1
Derate Programs
The Electronic Control Unit (ECU) will derate the amount of fuel that is delivered to the engine when sensor inputs exceed normal operating ranges. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) always accompanies a fuel derate. See APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for sensor derate specifications on your application.
RG40854,000002F 1904DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-13
PN=99
03 140 14
RG40854,000002E 1904DEC011/1
RG40854,0000030 1904DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-14
RG8552
1918SEP98
PN=100
03 140 15
NOTE: If the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DST) or SERVICE ADVISOR is used to read a sensor voltage and calculated value, and there is an active DTC for that sensor, the calculated value for that sensor will be the limp home value and the voltage will be the actual sensor voltage. Use the voltage during diagnostics unless otherwise directed by a diagnostic chart.
There are several different methods of displaying both stored and active DTCs from the ECU. SPN/FMI CODES SPN/FMI codes are written from the SAE J1939 standard as a two part code. The first part is called the
RG,RG34710,1540 1930SEP971/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-15
PN=101
03 140 16
RG,RG34710,1540 1930SEP972/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
03-140-16
PN=102
Section 04
Diagnostics
Contents
Page Page
Group 150Observable Diagnostics and Tests About This Group of the Manual . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-1 Level 12 ECU - E1 - Engine Cranks/Wont Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-2 Level 12 ECU - E1 - Engine Cranks/Wont Start Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-2 Level 12 ECU - E2 - Engine Misfires/Runs Irregularly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-7 Level 12 ECU - E2 - Engine Misfires/Runs Irregularly Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . .04-150-7 Level 12 ECU - E3 - Engine Does Not Develop Full Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-11 Level 12 ECU - E3 - Engine Does Not Develop Full Power Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-11 Level 12 ECU - E4 - Engine Emits Excessive White Exhaust Smoke. . . . . . . .04-150-16 Level 12 ECU - E4 - Engine Emits Excessive White Exhaust Smoke Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-16 Level 12 ECU - E5 - Engine Emits Excessive Black Or Gray Smoke . . . . . . . .04-150-19 Level 12 ECU - E5 - Engine Emits Excessive Black Or Gray Smoke Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-19 Level 12 ECU - E6 - Engine Will Not Crank. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-22 Level 12 ECU - E7 - Engine Idles Poorly . . .04-150-22 Level 12 ECU - E8 - Abnormal Engine Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-23 Level 12 ECU - E9 - Analog Throttle (B) Does Not Respond . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-25 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-26 Level 12 ECU - F1 - Fuel Supply System Check Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-26 Level 12 ECU - F2 - Excessive Fuel Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Level 12 ECU - F3 - Fuel in Oil. . . . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Level 12 ECU - F5 - Fuel Injection Nozzle Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-30 Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate With DST or SERVICE ADVISOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-32 Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate With DST or SERVICE ADVISOR - Continued . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-33 CTM331 (09APR02)
Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate with DST or SERVICE ADVISOR Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . .04-150-33 Level 12 ECU - D2 - Diagnostic Gauge Does Not Communicate With ECU . . . . . .04-150-36 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-37 Level 12 ECU - D2 - Diagnostic Gauge Does Not Communicate With ECU Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-37 Level 12 ECU - A1 - Intake Air Heater Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Level 12 ECU - A1 - Intake Air Heater Check - Continued . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-43 Level 12 ECU - A1 - Intake Air Heater Check Diagnostic Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-44 Check Fuel Supply Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-47 Test for Fuel Drain Back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-48 Test for Air in Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-49 Check Fuel Supply Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-50 Bench Test Fuel Supply Pump . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-51 Bleed the Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-53 Test for Cylinder Misfire (Engine Running) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-56 Group 160Trouble Code Diagnostics and Tests About this Group of the Manual. . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-1 Electrical Concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-1 Using a Digital Multimeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2 Electrical Circuit Malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2 Troubleshooting Circuit Malfunctions . . . . . . . .04-160-5 Engine Configuration Data Parameters on Diagnostic Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-10 Viewing Active DTCs on Diagnostic Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Viewing Stored DTCs on Diagnostic Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Clearing Stored DTCs on Diagnostic Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-13 Connecting to Diagnostic Scan Tool (DST) or SERVICE ADVISOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-14 Blinking DTCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-15 Data Parameter Description . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-16 Engine Test Instructions - Excavator Torque Curve Change Test . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-19
Continued on next page
04
04-1
PN=1
Contents
Page
Page
04
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) . . . . . . . . .04-160-20 Listing of Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) on ECU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-22 Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-27 Intermittent Fault Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-28 Listing of Throttle Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-29 Level 12 ECU - T1 - Multi-state Throttle Input High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-30 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-31 Level 12 ECU - T1 - Multi-State Throttle Input High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-31 Level 12 ECU - T2 - Multi-state Throttle Input Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-34 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-35 Level 12 ECU - T2 - Multi-State Throttle Input Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-35 Level 12 ECU - T3 - Analog Throttle (A) Input High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-38 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-39 Level 12 ECU - T3 - Analog Throttle (A) Input High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-39 Level 12 ECU - T4 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-42 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-43 Level 12 ECU - T4 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-43 Level 12 ECU - T5 - Analog Throttle (B) Input High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-46 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-47 Level 12 ECU - T5 - Analog Throttle (B) Input High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-47 Level 12 ECU - T6 - Analog Throttle (B) Input Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-51 Level 12 ECU - T6 - Analog Throttle (B) Input Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . .04-160-51 Level 12 ECU - T7 - CAN Throttle Invalid . . .04-160-54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-55 Level 12 ECU - T7 - CAN Throttle Invalid Diagnostic Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-55 Level 12 ECU - T11 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-58 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-59 Level 12 ECU - T11 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-59 Level 12 ECU - T12 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-62 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-63 Level 12 ECU - T12 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-63 CTM331 (09APR02)
Level 12 ECU - T13 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-67 Level 12 ECU - T13 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-67 Level 12 ECU - T14 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-70 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-71 Level 12 ECU - T14 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-71 Level 12 ECU - T15 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-74 Level 12 ECU - T15 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage High - Continued . . . . . . . . .04-160-75 Level 12 ECU - T15 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-75 Level 12 ECU - T16 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-78 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-79 Level 12 ECU - T16 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-79 Level 12 ECU - T19 - Throttle Not Calibrated Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-81 Level 12 ECU - T20 - Throttle Input Voltage Below Lower Calibration Limit . . . .04-160-82 Level 12 ECU - T21 - Throttle Calibration Aborted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-83 Level 12 ECU - T22 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage Out of Range . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-84 Level 12 ECU - T23 - Multi-state Throttle Input Voltage Out of Range . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-85 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 28, 29, 91 FMI 3, 4, 7, 9, 10, 13, 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low. . . . . .04-160-88 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-90 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-90 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage High. . .04-160-92 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-93 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-93 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage Low . . .04-160-96
Continued on next page
04-2
PN=2
Contents
Page
Page
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-98 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-98 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 Engine Oil Pressure Moderately Low . . . .04-160-102 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-103 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 Engine Oil Pressure Moderately Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-103 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-104 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-105 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-105 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-108 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-109 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-109 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 Manifold Air Temperature Moderately High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-112 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-113 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 Manifold Air Temperature Moderately High Diagnostic Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-113 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 Engine Coolant Temperature High Most Severe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-115 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 Engine Coolant Temperature High Most Severe Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-115 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-116 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-117 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-117 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-120 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-121 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-121 CTM331 (09APR02)
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 Engine Coolant Temperature High Least Severe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-124 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-125 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 Engine Coolant Temperature High Least Severe Diagnostic Procedure. . . . . . . . . .04-160-125 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 Engine Coolant Temperature High Moderately Severe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-126 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-127 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 Engine Coolant Temperature High Moderately Severe Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-127 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-128 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-129 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-129 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-131 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-131 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-134 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-135 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-135 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU Power Down Error. . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-138 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-139 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU Power Down Error Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-139 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage High . . . . . . .04-160-142 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-143 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-143 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Low . . . . . . . .04-160-146 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-147
Continued on next page
04
04-3
PN=3
Contents
Page
Page
04
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-147 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 Fuel Temperature Moderately High . . . . .04-160-150 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-151 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 Fuel Temperature Moderately High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-151 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 Engine Overspeed Extreme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-154 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 Engine Overspeed Moderate . . . . . . . . . .04-160-155 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High . . . . . . . . . .04-160-156 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-157 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-157 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low. . . . . . . . . . .04-160-160 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-161 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-161 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU Unswitched Power Missing . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-164 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-165 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU Unswitched Power Missing Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-165 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 629 FMI 13 ECU Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-168 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 629 FMI 13 ECU Error Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . .04-160-168 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 Crank Position Input Noise . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-170 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-171 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 Crank Position Input Noise Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-171 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 Crank Position Input Pattern Error . . . . . .04-160-174 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-175 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 Crank Position Input Pattern Error Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-175 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-178 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-179 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN Error Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . .04-160-179 CTM331 (09APR02)
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 898 FMI 9 Vehicle Speed or Torque Message Invalid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-181 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 970 FMI 31 Auxiliary Engine Shutdown Switch Active . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-182 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 971 FMI 31 External Engine Derate Switch Active . . .04-160-183 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-184 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-185 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-185 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-188 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-189 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-189 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 Pump Solenoid Current High . . . . . . . . . .04-160-192 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-193 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 Pump Solenoid Current High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-193 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 Pump Solenoid Circuit Open . . . . . . . . . .04-160-196 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-197 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 Pump Solenoid Circuit Open Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-197 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-201 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-201 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-204 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-205 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-205 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-208
Continued on next page
04-4
PN=4
Contents
Page
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-209 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted Diagnostic Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-209 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High . . . . . . . . . .04-160-212 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-213 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-213 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low. . . . . . . . . . .04-160-216 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-217 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-217 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1109 FMI 31 Engine Protection Shutdown Warning . . .04-160-220 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1110 FMI 31 Engine Protection Shutdown . . . . . . . . . .04-160-221 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1569 FMI 31 Fuel Derate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-222 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 2000 FMI 6 Internal ECU Failure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-223 Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 2000 FMI 13 Security Violation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-224
04
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-5
PN=5
Contents
04
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-6
PN=6
Group 150
NOTE: Follow the diagnostic procedure of an active or stored DTC before pursuing any observable diagnostic procedure. NOTE: To diagnose observable symptoms on engines with a mechanical fuel system, see 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Mechanical Fuel Systems Manual (CTM 207).
(E) Diagnosing General Engine Malfunctions: E1 - Engine cranks/wont start E2 - Engine misfires/runs irregularly E3 - Engine does not develop full power E4 - Engine emits excessive white exhaust smoke E5 - Engine emits excessive black or gray smoke E6 - Engine will not crank E7 - Engine idles poorly E8 - Abnormal engine noise E9 - Analog Throttle (B) Does Not Respond (F) Diagnosing Fuel System Malfunctions:
04 150 1
RG40854,0000113 1916JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-1
PN=105
RG40854,00000D3 1902JAN021/1
1 E1 - Preliminary Check
Before using this diagnostic procedure: 1. Ensure that fuel quality and quantity are OK. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY QUALITY later in this Group. 2. Ensure that engine cranking speed is OK. See TEST ENGINE CRANKING SPEED in Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). 3. Ensure that oil viscosity is correct. 4. Verify air heater operation in cold temperatures
1/1
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU Communication Software 4. Crank engine for 15 seconds 5. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
No active DTCs present: GO TO 3 Active DTC(s) present: Diagnose DTCs. If any of the DTCs have a SPN 637, diagnose them first. Can not communicate with ECU: See D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE later in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-2
PN=106
NOTE: For an explanation of this parameter, see DATA PARAMETER DESCRIPTION in Group 160.
1/1
Inspect the vehicle for possible failures that can cause either of the following conditions: 1. Bad electrical connections 2. Damaged engine speed sensor 3. EMI from improperly installed radio equipment, or other electronic devices 4. Once problem is found, repair and retest.
04 150 3
1/1
CAUTION: Escaping fluid under pressure can penetrate the skin causing serious injury. Keep hands and body away from pinholes and nozzles which could inject fluids under high pressure. If ANY fluid is injected into the skin, it must be surgically removed within a few hours by a doctor familiar with this type of injury or gangrene may result. Doctors unfamiliar with this type of injury may call the Deere and Company Medical Department in Moline, Illinois, or other knowledgeable medical source. 1. Using two open-end wrenches, loosen fuel line connection at one of the injection nozzles. 2. Crank engine while monitoring loosened connection for consistent squirts of fuel. 3. Retighten connection at nozzle to specification. Specification Fuel Injection Nozzle Delivery Lines Torque .................................................................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-3
PN=107
1/1
04 150 4
Check for intake and exhaust restrictions. See CHECK FOR INTAKE AND EXHAUST RESTRICTIONS in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
All components operating correctly: GO TO 8 Restrictions are found: Repair faulty component and retest.
1/1
8 Compression Test
Check compression pressure. See TEST ENGINE COMPRESSION PRESSURE in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5L & 6.8L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
Test fuel injection nozzles. See F5 - FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE CHECK later in this Group.
Injection nozzles OK: Faulty injection pump. Faulty injection nozzle(s) found: Repair or replace injection nozzle(s)
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-4
PN=108
NOTE: DO NOT use too much oil. DO NOT get oil on the valves.
1. Apply oil to ring area of piston through injection nozzle bore. See REMOVE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Retest the compression pressure.
1/1
Check valve lash. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
Valve lash is within specification: GO TO 12 Valve lash on one or more valves out of specification: Adjust valve lash and retest.
04 150 5
1/1
Check valve lift. See MEASURE VALVE LIFT in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
Lift on all valves within specification: GO TO 13 Valve lift on one or more valves is out of specification: Reset clearance to specification after measuring lift. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-5
PN=109
1/1
04 150 6
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-6
PN=110
RG40854,00000D4 1902JAN021/1
1/1
1 E2 - Preliminary Check
Before using this diagnostic procedure, make the following checks that could cause or be mistaken as miss/rough running: 1. Check for intake manifold air leaks 2. Check for mechanical problems 3. Check for transmission problems 4. Check engine accessories, such as A/C, cycling on and off 5. Check for electromegnetic interference (EMI) from improperly installed radios, etc.
04 150 7
1/1
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU Communication Software 4. Ignition ON, engine idling 5. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
No active DTCs: GO TO 3 Active DTCs present: Diagnose DTCs. If any of the DTCs have a SPN 637, diagnose them first
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-7
PN=111
1/1
No active DTCs: GO TO 6 Active DTCs present: Diagnose DTCs. If any of the DTCs have a SPN 637, diagnose them first.
1/1
Check for head gasket joint failures. See CHECK FOR HEAD GASKET FAILURES in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
No sign of head gasket failure: GO TO 7 Signs of head gasket failure found: Replace head gasket and retest.
1/1
Check cylinders for misfire. See TEST FOR CYLINDER MISFIRE (ENGINE RUNNING) later in this Group.
Single cylinder misfire: GO TO 8 Random or all cylinder misfire: See F1 - FUEL SUPPLY SYSTEM CHECK DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE later in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-8
PN=112
1/1
Perform the following steps to determine if fuel delivery lines are restricted: 1. Disconnect the suspected fuel delivery line on the injection nozzle end and injection pump end. 2. Force air through one end of the delivery line. 3. If the delivery line is not restricted, the compressed air should flow freely out the other side. 4. If air does not flow freely, there are restrictions in the fuel line.
Lines are not restricted: GO TO 10 Lines are restricted: Repair or replace lines and retest.
04 150 9
1/1
Test fuel injection nozzles. See F5 - FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE CHECK later in this Group.
Injection nozzles test OK: Faulty injection pump Faulty injection nozzle(s) found: Repair or replace injection nozzles.
1/1
NOTE: DO NOT use too much oil. DO NOT get oil on the valves.
1. Apply oil to ring area of piston through injection nozzle bore. See REMOVE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Retest the compression pressure.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-9
PN=113
1/1
Check valve lift. See MEASURE VALVE LIFT in Group 020 in Section 02 of 4.5L & 6.8L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
Lift on all valves within specification: GO TO 14 Valve lift on one or more valves is out of specification: Reset clearance to specification after measuring lift. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
At this point, the most likely cause of the low engine compression pressure is one of the following failures in the pistons, rings, and/or cylinder liners or in the valve guides. Check the most likely items as needed. Oil control rings worn or broken Scored cylinder liners or pistons Piston ring grooves excessively worn Piston rings sticking in ring grooves Insufficient piston ring tension Piston ring gaps not staggered Cylinder liners glazed (insufficient load during engine break-in) Worn valve guides or stems Cylinder head may need reconditioning
Problem found with pistons, rings, and/or liners or valve guides: Repair problem as necessary.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-10
PN=114
RG40854,00000D5 1902JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - E3 - Engine Does Not Develop Full Power Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 E3 - Preliminary Check
Before using this diagnostic procedure, ensure that: There are no problems with transmission There are no engine mechanical problems There is not an excessive load on the engine There is no unbalanced ballast The air and fuel filters are not restricted or plugged Fuel quality is OK
04 150 11
1/1
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU Communication Software 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
NOTE: On some DTCs, the ECU derates fuel in order to protect the engine.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-11
PN=115
04 150 12
1/1
The ECU on 4.5L & 6.8L diesel engines has the ability to operate on multiple torque curves. To check that the engine is operating on the correct torque curve under the operating conditions where there is a low power complaint: 1. Recreate the conditions of the low power complaint. 2. Read the Torque Curve parameter on the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Correct torque curve number displayed for corresponding operating conditions: GO TO 5 Incorrect torque curve number displayed for corresponding operating conditions: Refer to machine manual to determine components that if faulty could prevent the correct torque curve from being selected OR Faulty torque curve select wiring
NOTE: For an explanation of this parameter, see DATA PARAMETER DESCRIPTION in Group 160.
3. Compare the Torque Curve Parameter to the appropriate torque curve chart. See APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual and refer to the corresponding torque curve for your application.
1/1
1. Operate engine and attempt to recreate the low power condition. 2. Read the Desired Speed Governor parameter and the Maximum Speed Governor parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Correct governor selection: GO TO 6 Incorrect governor selection: Refer to machine manual to determine components that if faulty could prevent the correct governor from being selected OR Faulty governor select wiring
1/1
NOTE: For an explanation of this parameter, see DATA PARAMETER DESCRIPTION in Group 160.
3. Compare governor selection to the appropriate governor mode chart. See APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual and refer to the corresponding maximum speed and desired speed governor curves for your application.
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-12
PN=116
NOTE: For an explanation of this parameter, see DATA PARAMETER DESCRIPTION in Group 160.
1/1
Check the Turbo Boost pressure. See MEASURE INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE (TURBOCHARGER BOOST/POWER CHECK) in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
Intake manifold pressure within range or above, compared to boost specification: GO TO 8 Intake manifold pressure below range compared to boost specification: GO TO 9
04 150 13
1/1
Check the fuel supply system. See F1 - FUEL SUPPLY SYSTEM CHECK DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE later in this Group.
Fuel supply system is OK: Engine appears to be delivering full power. Check for vehicle problems that could cause an excessive load on the engine. Fuel supply system problem found: Repair fuel supply system problem and retest.
1/1
Check compression pressure. See TEST ENGINE COMPRESSION PRESSURE Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-13
PN=117
1/1
Check the fuel supply system. F1 - FUEL SUPPLY SYSTEM CHECK DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE later in this Group.
Fuel supply system is OK: GO TO 12 Fuel supply system problem found: Repair fuel supply system problem and retest.
1/1
Test fuel injection nozzles. See F5 - FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE CHECK later in this Group.
Injection nozzles test OK: Faulty injection pump OR Faulty ECU Faulty injection nozzle(s) found: Repair or replace faulty injection nozzles.
1/1
NOTE: DO NOT use too much oil. DO NOT get oil on the valves.
1. Apply oil to ring area of piston through injection nozzle bore. See REMOVE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Retest the compression pressure.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-14
PN=118
1/1
Check valve lift. See MEASURE VALVE LIFT in Group 020 in Section 02 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
Lift on all valves within specification: GO TO 16 Valve lift on one or more valves is out of specification: Reset clearance to specification after measuring lift. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
04 150 15
1/1
At this point, the most likely cause of the low engine compression pressure is one of the following failures in the pistons, rings, and/or cylinder liners or in the valve guides. Check the most likely items as needed. Oil control rings worn or broken Scored cylinder liners or pistons Piston ring grooves excessively worn Piston rings sticking in ring grooves Insufficient piston ring tension Piston ring gaps not staggered Cylinder liners glazed (insufficient load during engine break-in) Worn valve guides or stems Cylinder head may need reconditioning
Problem found with pistons, rings, and/or liners or valve guides: Repair problem as necessary.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-15
PN=119
RG40854,00000D6 1902JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - E4 - Engine Emits Excessive White Exhaust Smoke Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This procedure should be used if the engine emits excessive white exhaust smoke. This type of smoke causes a burning sensation to the eyes. If engine emits a less heavy, bluish exhaust smoke see 4.5L/6.8L - L1 EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
04 150 16
1/1
1 E4 - Preliminary Check
Before using this diagnostic procedure: Ensure fuel quantity and quality are OK. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY QUALITY later in this Group. Ensure engine coolant temperature is not extremely low.
Check for a failed head gasket. See CHECK FOR HEAD GASKET FAILURES in Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
No signs of head gasket failure: GO TO 3 Signs of head gasket failure are found: See CHECK FOR HEAD GASKET FAILURES in Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
1/1
Check compression pressure. See TEST ENGINE COMPRESSION PRESSURE Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-16
PN=120
1/1
Test fuel injection nozzles. See F5 - FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE CHECK later in this Group.
Injection nozzles test good: Faulty injection pump Faulty injection nozzle(s) found: Repair or replace injection nozzles
04 150 17
1/1
NOTE: DO NOT use too much oil. DO NOT get oil on the valves.
1. Apply oil to ring area of piston through injection nozzle bore. See REMOVE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Retest the compression pressure.
1/1
1. Ensure there are no engine mechanical problems and that there isnt something drawing excessive engine power 2. Ensure that valve lash is correctly adjusted. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
Valve clearance within specification: GO TO 8 Valve clearance out of specification: Adjust valves to specification and retest.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-17
PN=121
04 150 18
1/1
At this point, the most likely cause of the low engine compression pressure is one of the following failures in the pistons, rings, and/or cylinder liners or in the valve guides. Check the most likely items as needed. Oil control rings worn or broken Scored cylinder liners or pistons Piston ring grooves excessively worn Piston rings sticking in ring grooves Insufficient piston ring tension Piston ring gaps not staggered Cylinder liners glazed (insufficient load during engine break-in) Worn valve guides or stems Cylinder head may need reconditioning
Problem found with pistons, rings, and/or liners or valve guides: Repair problem as necessary.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-18
PN=122
RG40854,00000D7 1902JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - E5 - Engine Emits Excessive Black Or Gray Smoke Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This procedure should be used if the engine emits excessive black or gray smoke. If engine emits a less heavy, bluish exhaust smoke see 4.5L/6.8L - L1 - EXCESSIVE OIL CONSUMPTION in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Manual (CTM 104).
04 150 19
1/1
1 E5 - Preliminary Check
Before using this diagnostic procedure, check the following: Ensure fuel quantity and quality are OK. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY QUALITY later in this Group. Ensure engine is not excessively loaded Ensure air filter is not restricted or plugged
NOTE: This check is only required for Excavators. For all other applications, GO TO 3 .
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. With the engine running, read the Torque Curve parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Correct torque curve number displayed: GO TO 3 Incorrect torque curve number displayed: Adjust torque curve using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. See ENGINE TEST INSTRUCTIONS EXCAVATOR TORQUE CURVE CHANGE TEST in Section 4, Group 160 of this manual.
NOTE: For an explanation of this parameter, see DATA PARAMETER DESCRIPTION in Group 160.
3. Compare the Torque Curve Parameter to the appropriate torque curve chart. See EXCAVATORS - TORQUE CURVE SELECTION in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-19
PN=123
1/1
Check for turbocharger failure. See TURBOCHARGER INSPECTION in Section 02, Group 080 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
No turbocharger failure found: GO TO 5 Turbocharger failure found: Follow appropriate repair procedure in Group 080 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
1/1
Check valve lash. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM104).
Valve lash on all valves within specification: GO TO 6 Valve lash on one or more valves out of specification: Adjust valve lash and retest
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-20
PN=124
1/1
04 150 21
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-21
PN=125
Weak battery
Replace battery.
Corroded or loose battery connections Defective main switch or start safety switch Starter solenoid defective
04 150 22
Replace solenoid. Replace starter. Check wiring, fuses, and relays. Check by rotating engine by hand.
RG40854,00000D8 1902JAN021/1
Drain fuel and replace with quality fuel of the proper grade. Check hose and pipe connections for tightness; repair as required. See AIR INTAKE AND EXHAUST SYSTEM SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 200 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). See E2 - ENGINE MISFIRES/RUNS IRREGULARLY DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group.
RG40854,00000DA 1902JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-22
PN=126
Determine bearing clearance. See CYLINDER BLOCK, LINERS, PISTONS, AND RODS SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 200 or CRANKSHAFT , MAIN BEARINGS, AND FLYWHEEL SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 200 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Check crankshaft end play. See CHECK CRANKSHAFT END PLAY in Section 02, Group 040 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Check bearing clearance; replace bearings and bearing cap screws as required. See CRANKSHAFT , MAIN BEARINGS, AND FLYWHEEL SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 200 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Inspect piston pins and bushings. See INSPECT PISTON PINS AND BUSHINGS in Section 02, Group 030 of 4.5 & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Inspect pistons. See PRELIMINARY LINER, PISTON, AND ROD CHECKS in Section 02, Group 030 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Check timing gear back lash. See MEASURE TIMING GEAR BACKLASH in Section 02, Group 050 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
04 150 23
Scored pistons
RG40854,00000DB 1902JAN021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-23
PN=127
Solution
Check and adjust valve clearance. See CHECK AND ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Inspect camshaft. See VISUALLY INSPECT CAMSHAFT in Section 02, Group 050 of 4.5 & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Inspect rocker arm shafts. See DISASSEMBLE AND INSPECT ROCKER ARM SHAFT ASSEMBLY in Section 02, Group 020 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). See 4.5L/6.8L - L2 - ENGINE OIL PRESSURE LOW in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). See TURBOCHARGER INSPECTION in Section 02, Group 080 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
Worn camshaft
Turbocharger noise
RG40854,00000DB 1902JAN022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-24
PN=128
Read DTCs on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Go to the diagnostic procedure for the corresponding DTC. See T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE in Group 160 of this manual.
04 150 25
RG40854,0000145 1911FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-25
PN=129
RG40854,00000DD 1902JAN021/1
1/1
04 150 26
1 F1 - Preliminary Check
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
Before using this diagnostic procedure: Ensure fuel quantity and quality are OK. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY QUALITY after this Group. Inspect all fuel lines and fittings for ruptures or leaks. If fuel system has recently been opened, bleed fuel system. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM later in this Group.
1/1
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
Check for air in the fuel. See TEST FOR AIR IN FUEL later in this Group.
No air found in fuel system: GO TO 3 Air found in fuel system: Bleed fuel system. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM later in this Group.
1/1
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
Check fuel supply pressure. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY PRESSURE later in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-26
PN=130
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
1. Replace final fuel filter and retest. 2. Replace prefilter (if equipped) and retest. 3. Check fuel supply pressure. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY PRESSURE later in this Group.
1/1
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
Remove fuel supply lines and determine if there are any internal restrictions.
04 150 27
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
At this point, the most likely cause for low fuel pressure is a failure in the fuel supply pump. See BENCH TEST FUEL SUPPLY PUMP later in this Group.
1/1
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
1. Disconnect fuel line from injection pump overflow valve. 2. Loosen overflow valve from injection pump. 3. Turn ignition switch to ON position. 4. Operate hand primer on fuel supply pump until fuel flows out the overflow valve fitting location. If fuel flow out the hole cannot be obtained, retighten all fittings.
Good fuel flow out of loose overflow valve: No fuel supply problem found. NOT good fuel flow or no flow out of loose overflow valve: GO TO 8
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-27
PN=131
NOTE: For fuel system operation information, see FUEL SYSTEM OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 earlier in this manual.
This check will help determine if the pre-injection fuel line is restricted. Disconnect fuel line from the final filter to the injection pump. Force air through the fuel line.
No restrictions found: No fuel supply problems found. Return to diagnostic procedure earlier in this Group for: E1 - ENGINE CRANKS/WONT START DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE OR E3 - ENGINE DOES NOT DEVELOP FULL POWER DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE Restrictions found: Repair or replace components as needed.
04 150 28
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-28
PN=132
Drain fuel and replace with quality fuel of the proper grade. Reduce engine load Replace air cleaner element as required. Determine cause of low compression and repair as required. Locate source of leak and repair as required.
04 150 29
RG40854,00000DE 1902JAN021/1
RG40854,00000DF 1902JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-29
PN=133
Performance Tests - See FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE TEST in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Disassembly - See DISASSEMBLE FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Adjusting - See ADJUST FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Installing Seals - See INSTALL SEALS ON FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Installation - See INSTALL FUEL INJECTION NOZZLES in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual.
Solution
Nozzle replaced without using new seal or washer Carbon stop seal groove not cleaned when new seal was installed.
Clean groove and install new seal and washer. Clean greave and install new seal.
Improper adjustment
Adjust opening pressure. See FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE TEST in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Replace spring Clean orifices. Replace injection nozzle Adjust lift screw. Clean orifices. Replace injection nozzle Replace injection nozzle. Clean orifice. Replace injection nozzle Replace injection nozzle.
Broken spring Nozzle Will Not Open Plugged orifices Chipped orifices Bottomed lift screw Poor Spray Pattern Plugged orifices Chipped orifices Cracked nozzle tip Poor Atomization Plugged orifice Chipped orifice Cracked nozzle tip
RG40854,0000001 1906MAR021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-30
PN=134
Solution
Seat Leakage
Clean seat. Lap valve to seat. Replace nozzle as necessary. Lap tip to seat. Replace nozzle as necessary. See FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE TEST in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. Replace injection nozzle Replace injection nozzle Lap valve to guide. Replace nozzle as necessary. Clean Guide Area Clean nozzle. Lap valve to guide. Replace injection nozzle as necessary.
04 150 31
Low Leak-Off
RG40854,0000001 1906MAR022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-31
PN=135
Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate With DST or SERVICE ADVISOR
CAN Low CAN High CAN Shield F1 G1
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
E F G
04 150 32
D C A J H B
D C E B A
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3
C O N N E C T O R
K1 K2 K3
Diagnostic Connector
C C CAN Terminator This diagnostic procedure should be used if communication between the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DST) or SERVICE ADVISOR and the Engine Control
Unit (ECU) cannot be established. For more information on CAN, see CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN) in Group 130 earlier in this manual.
RG40854,00000E0 1902JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-32
PN=136
RG11972
1914DEC01
B B A C
Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate With DST or SERVICE ADVISOR Continued
RG40854,00000E9 1904JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - D1 - ECU Does Not Communicate with DST or SERVICE ADVISOR Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the diagnostic connector, and all connections in between. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 150 33
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. Make sure all communication cables are properly connected 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Start the ECU Communication Software
DST or Service ADVISOR does not communicate with ECU: GO TO 3 DST or Service ADVISOR communicates with ECU: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECT sensor 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between both terminals of the selected sensor harness connector
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-33
PN=137
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between a good ground and terminal A2 in the harness end of the ECU connector
3.0 V or above: Faulty ECU power fuse OR Faulty ECU power wiring OR Faulty ECU Below 3.0 V: Key-on signal wire open or shorted to ground OR Faulty ignition switch OR Faulty key-on power fuse
1/1
04 150 34
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition ON 2. Observe the power light on the Parallel Data Module (PDM)
Green power light ON: GO TO 8 Red power light or power light OFF: GO TO 6
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between switched voltage terminal and ground terminal of the harness end of the diagnostic connector
Substantially less than battery voltage: GO TO 7 At or near battery voltage: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Faulty diagnostic cable OR Faulty Parallel Port Data Module (PDM)
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector 3. Probe the ground terminal in the harness side of the diagnostic connector with a test light connected to battery voltage.
Light ON: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Open or short in power wire Light OFF: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Open ground wire
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-34
PN=138
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector and diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance on the harness end of both connectors between: CAN low terminal D in the diagnostic connector and terminal F1 in the ECU connector CAN high terminal C in the diagnostic connector and terminal G1 in the ECU connector
Both measurements 5 ohms or less: GO TO 9 One or more measurements greater than 5 ohms: Open in harness circuit
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. ECU and diagnostic connector still disconnected. 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminals C and D in the harness end of the diagnostic connector.
Between 45 - 75 ohms: GO TO 10 Less than 45 or greater than 75 ohms: Faulty or missing CAN terminator connector OR Open or short in CAN wiring harness
04 150 35
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see D1 - ECU DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH DST OR SERVICE ADVISOR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Reconnect ECU connector 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between a good chassis ground and : Terminal C in the diagnostic connector Terminal D in the diagnostic connector
Both measurements between 1.5 - 3.5 volts: Faulty ECU/Cab Harness connection OR Faulty diagnostic cable OR Faulty diagnostic connector OR Faulty Parallel Port Data Module (PDM) OR Faulty diagnostic software/computer configuration OR Faulty ECU Either measurement less than 1.5 or greater than 3.5 volts: CAN wiring shorted to ground or voltage OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-35
PN=139
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3
H G F
A B C D
04 150 36
B G F E D
H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
C O N N E C T O R
NOTE: For more information on CAN, see CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN) in Group 130 earlier in this manual.
Internal Diagnostic Gauge Errors The D2 - Diagnostic Gauge Does Not Communicate With ECU diagnostic procedure should be followed if
the diagnostic gauge shows the following error codes or it can not communicate with the ECU: EE-error ACP-Err/No Addr ACP-Err/Bus EP ACP-Err/Bus Error
RG40854,00000E2 1902JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-36
PN=140
RG11973
1914DEC01
Level 12 ECU - D2 - Diagnostic Gauge Does Not Communicate With ECU - Continued
RG40854,0000147 1911FEB021/1
Level 12 ECU - D2 - Diagnostic Gauge Does Not Communicate With ECU Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the diagnostic gauge connector, and all connections in between. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 150 37
1/1
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Ignition ON
Error or no power found in diagnostic gauge: GO TO 3 No error found and power present in diagnostic gauge: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-37
PN=141
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect any of the following: Fuel temperature sensor MAT sensor ECT sensor 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between both terminals of the selected sensor harness connector.
04 150 38
1/1
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between a good ground and terminal A2 in the harness end of the ECU connector.
3.0 V or above: Faulty ECU power fuse OR Faulty ECU power wiring OR Faulty ECU Below 3.0 V: Key-on signal wire open or short to ground OR Faulty ignition switch OR Faulty key-on power fuse
1/1
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition ON 2. View diagnostic gauge
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between switched voltage terminal and ground terminal of the harness end of the diagnostic connector
Substantially less than battery voltage: GO TO 7 At or near battery voltage: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Faulty diagnostic cable OR Faulty Parallel Port Data Module (PDM)
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-38
PN=142
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector 3. Probe the ground terminal in the harness side of the diagnostic connector with a test light connected to battery voltage.
Light ON: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Open or short in power wire Light OFF: Faulty diagnostic connector OR Open ground wire
1/1
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the ECU connector and the diagnostic cable from the diagnostic connector. 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance on the harness end of both connectors between: Terminal B in the diagnostic gauge connector and terminal F1 in the ECU connector. Terminal G in the diagnostic gauge connector and terminal G1 in the ECU connector.
All measurements 5 ohms or less: GO TO 9 One or more measurements greater than 5 ohms: Open in harness circuit OR Connector terminals in wrong position
04 150 39
1/1
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. ECU and diagnostic connectors still disconnected. 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminals B and G in the harness end of the diagnostic connector.
Between 45-75 ohms: GO TO 10 Less than 45 or greater than 75 ohms: Faulty or missing CAN terminator connector(s) OR Open or short in CAN wiring harness
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-39
PN=143
NOTE: For wiring information, see D2 - DIAGNOSTIC GAUGE DOES NOT COMMUNICATE WITH ECU supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Reconnect ECU connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between a good chassis ground and: Terminal B in the diagnostic gauge connector Terminal G in the diagnostic gauge connector
Both measurements between 1.5 - 3.5 V: Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty diagnostic gauge connection OR Faulty diagnostic software/computer configuration OR Faulty ECU Either measurement less than 1.5 V or greater than 3.5 V: CAN wiring shorted to ground or power OR Faulty ECU
04 150 40
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-40
PN=144
04 150 41
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-41
PN=145
F1 F2 F3
K3
G1 G2 G3
H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3
K1 K2 K3
04 150 42
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For non-OEM engine wiring information, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Intake Air Heater The intake air heater is located between the intake pipe and intake manifold. Its function is to heat the intake air during cold starting conditions. Its operation time is dependent on the fuel temperature that the ECU detects at key-on. The table on the corresponding page explains this relationship.
When the ECU sends battery voltage to the air heater relay, the solenoid in the relay activates, and the air heater turns ON. At this time, the ECU will illuminate the air heater indicator light. When the ECU stops sending battery voltage, the solenoid deactivates, and the air heater turns OFF. At this time, the ECU will turn the air heater indicator light OFF. To ensure full utilization of the intake air heater, the operator should wait until the light goes out before starting the engine. Anytime the engine cranks but does not start, a key-off/key-on cycle will be required before preheating is allowed again.
RG40854,00000E6 1903JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-42
RG12049
E CC UO N HN AE RC NT EO SR S
1923JAN02
PN=146
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-43
PN=147
RG40854,00000EB 1904JAN021/1
NOTE: The air heater indicator light is the same light that trouble codes are displayed on. If the light stays on past 25 seconds, check for trouble codes or a short to ground in the air heater indicator light wire.
1/1
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see A1 - INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, air heater relay connector, air heater connector, and all connections in between. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
1/1
NOTE: Do not run engine during this diagnostic procedure. NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see A1 - INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Key ON, engine OFF 2. Verify that the air heater indicator light is working
Light works: GO TO 3 Light does not work: Faulty air heater indicator light wiring OR Faulty air heater indicator light
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-44
PN=148
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see A1 - INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR in Group 160 later in this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU Communication Software 4. Key ON, engine OFF 5. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
04 150 45
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see LEVEL 12 - A1 - INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Key ON, engine OFF 2. Read the Fuel Temperature parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Below -5C (23F): GO TO 5 At or above -5C (23F): No air heater-related problem found
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see LEVEL 12 - A1 - INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Key OFF 2. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between the air heater power stud and a good chassis ground while turning key ON (engine OFF)
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see LEVEL 12 ECU - A1 INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Key OFF 2. Using a multimeter, measure the temperature of air heater housing 3. Key ON, engine OFF 4. Continue to monitor temperature of air heater housing
Temperature increases: No air heater related problem found Temperature does not increase Faulty air heater
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-45
PN=149
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see LEVEL 12 ECU - A1 INTAKE AIR HEATER CHECK supporting information
1. Key OFF 2. Listen for air heater relay to click while turning key ON (engine OFF)
Relay clicks: Faulty power wire to relay OR Faulty wire between relay and heater OR Faulty air heater relay Relay does not click: Faulty air heater enable wire OR Faulty relay ground OR Faulty relay
04 150 46
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-46
PN=150
04 150 47
The quality of diesel fuel affects engine performance. Check your operators manual for correct fuel specifications. Poor quality or contaminated fuel will make the engine hard to start, misfire, run rough or produce low power. If poor quality or contaminated fuel is suspected, perform the following: 1. Check prefilter (if equipped) and final fuel filter for serviceability. If filter is equipped with a water bowl, empty and clean water bowl. 2. Start engine and operate under load, observing engine performance.
3. Ignition OFF, engine off 4. Disconnect fuel line from inlet side of prefilter (if equipped) or inlet side of final filter on engines without prefilter. 5. Connect a hose to inlet port. 6. Submerge hose in a container of clean, good quality fuel meeting engine specifications. 7. Operate engine under load and observe performance. If performance improves, fuel is contaminated or not of the proper grade. Check fuel source.
RG40854,00000EC 1904JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-47
PN=151
RG11969
UN23JAN02
04 150 48
NOTE: Connections may allow air to enter the system without allowing fuel to leak out.
6. If any leaks are found, take necessary steps to repair. 7. Reconnect supply and return lines and prime system. 8. Start engine and run for approximately 10 minutes. 9. Allow engine to sit overnight and try starting the following morning.
RG40854,00000EE 1904JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-48
PN=152
04 150 49
NOTE: If engine cranks but wont start, see BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM later in this Group.
Air in the fuel system will make the engine hard to start, run rough, misfire or produce low power. Additionally, it can cause excessive smoke and knocking. Whenever the fuel system is opened for repair, it must be bled to remove any air that has entered the system. 1. Disconnect hose from end of fuel leak-off line assembly. Connect a clear plastic hose to end of leak-off line assembly and place opposite end of hose in a suitable container filled with fuel as shown.
2. Operate engine and check for air bubbles in container. If bubbles are present, bleed the fuel system and repeat test. See BLEED THE FUEL SYSTEM later in this Group. 3. If bubbles are still present, check the following: Check for loose fuel fittings from the suction side of the fuel supply pump to the fuel tank to include all lines and filters. Check fuel tank suction tube (if equipped) and welded joints for cracks or holes. Perform any necessary repairs, bleed fuel system and repeat test.
RG40854,00000EF 1904JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-49
PN=153
RG11970
UN23JAN02
RG40854,00000F9 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-50
RG7946
PN=154
NOTE: This test will give a good indication of condition of both the inlet and outlet valves, as well as the diaphragm. The numerical values obtained on both the vacuum and pressure sides are not important; rather it is the needle movement that is important (very slow for a good pump; very fast or not at all for a defective pump).
1. Remove inlet and outlet fittings. 2. Install vacuum/pressure gauge to inlet side of pump (C). 3. Move primer lever (D) all the way downward. Release lever and at the same time observe gauge: The gauge needle should read the same value each time, and then very slowly return to 0. This indicates that the inlet valve and diaphragm are in good condition. Proceed to next step. If the gauge needle does not move at all, or if the needle rapidly returns to 0, the pump is defective and must be replaced. 4. Remove vacuum/pressure gauge and install onto outlet side of pump (B). 5. Move primer lever all the way to upward position. Release lever and at same time observe gauge reading:
RG9052
UN16MAR98
04 150 51
RG40854,0000146 1911FEB021/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-51
PN=155
If the gauge needle initially reads same value as above and then returns immediately back to 0, the pump is defective and must be replaced.
04 150 52
RG40854,0000146 1911FEB022/3
Leakage Test The leakage test should be performed if a supply pump is suspected of leaking fuel externally, or internally into the engine crankcase. 1. Install an air line on inlet side of pump (C) and apply 140 kPa (1.4 bar) (20 psi) pressure. 2. Hold finger over outlet side of pump (B) or install a plug. Submerge pump into a container of clean diesel fuel.
Fuel Supply Pump with Metal Cover
UN16MAR98
If air bubbles occur around banded connection holding the two halves of pump together (indicating leakage), replace pump. If the diaphragm is bad, there will be leakage through vent holes (if equipped) and around the rocker arm. Replace pump as necessary.
RG40854,0000146 1911FEB023/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-52
PN=156
RG9052
X9811
UN23AUG88
04 150 53
RG40854,00000F0 1904JAN021/5
1. Loosen the air bleed vent screw (A) two full turns by hand on fuel filter base.
ABleed Vent Screw
UN25OCT01
RG40854,00000F0 1904JAN022/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-53
PN=157
RG11805
04 150 54
RG40854,00000F0 1904JAN023/5
At Fuel Injection Pump 1. Loosen fuel return line (A) at fuel injection pump. 2. Operate fuel supply pump primer lever or primer button on fuel filter base (if equipped). 3. As soon as fuel flow is free from air bubbles, tighten fuel return line to specifications. Primer lever is spring-loaded and will return to normal position.
Specification Fuel Injection Pump Return LineTorque ................................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
RG40854,00000F0 1904JAN024/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-54
PN=158
RG11807
UN25OCT01
RG11806
RG11808
UN25OCT01
04 150 55
4. Repeat procedure for remaining injection nozzles (if necessary) until all air has been removed from fuel system. If engine still will not start, see your authorized servicing dealer or engine distributor.
RG40854,00000F0 1904JAN025/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-55
PN=159
1. Operate engine at intermediate speed with no load. 2. Place a shop towel around nozzle-to-line connection to absorb escaping fuel. 3. Slowly loosen the fuel pressure line at one of the nozzles until fuel escapes at the connection (fuel not opening nozzle valve). If engine speed changes, the cylinder is probably working satisfactory. If engine speed does not change, a cylinder is faulty. 4. Tighten fuel lines to specifications.
Specification Fuel Injection Nozzle Delivery LinesTorque ................................................................. 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
5. Repeat test for each remaining cylinder. 6. Remove faulty injection nozzles and repair as required. See F5 - FUEL INJECTION NOZZLE CHECK earlier in this Group.
RG40854,00000F1 1904JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-150-56
PN=160
Group 160
Parts such as sensors, actuators, connectors, and wiring harnesses are serviceable and available. To help diagnose electronic control system problems, Section 06, Group 210 DIAGNOSTIC
NOTE: Instruction is given throughout the diagnostic charts to make resistance and voltage measurements in the ECU connector. Note that these measurements are always made in the harness end of the connector. Measurements should never be made in the ECU end of the connection.
04 160 1
RG40854,00000FA 1915JAN021/1
Electrical Concepts
Tests will include making measurements of voltage and resistance and making checks for open circuits and short circuits. An understanding of the following concepts is required to use the diagnostic procedures: Voltage (volts) Current (amps) Resistance (ohms) Open Circuit Short Circuit
RG40854,00000FB 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-1
PN=161
04 160 2
RG40854,00000FC 1915JAN021/1
RG40854,00000FD 1915JAN021/6
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-2
PN=162
RG11126
UN19JUN00
A circuit having unwanted resistance (A) that causes a voltage drop and reduces current flow.
04 160 3
Open Circuit
ABreak or Separation in Circuit
2. Open Circuit: A circuit having a break or a separation (A) that prevents current from flowing in the circuit.
Grounded Circuit
AVoltage Wire in Contact with Machine Frame
3. Grounded Circuit: A voltage wire in contact with the machine frame (A), providing continuity with the battery ground terminal.
RG40854,00000FD 1915JAN024/6
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-3
PN=163
Shorted Circuit
04 160 4
4. Shorted Circuit: A wire-to-wire contact of two adjacent wires that provides unwanted continuity between the two wires. The following are types of short circuits: Voltage wire shorted to another voltage wire (wires of equal or unequal voltage). Voltage wire shorted to a sensor signal wire (wires of unequal voltage). Voltage wire shorted to a ground wire (wires of battery voltage or regulated voltage, shorted to a
ground wire connecting a component to the battery negative terminal). Ground wire shorted to another ground wire (wires of zero voltage).
NOTE: This type of short does not create an observable malfunction. Therefore, no further explanation for trouble shooting is necessary.
Locations of Circuit Malfunctions: In a Simple Electrical Circuit the circuit malfunctions occur at only three locations. They are: 1. Before the controlling switch (A). 2. Between the controlling switch (A) and the load (B). 3. After the load (B). Electrical components can become faulty with the same four circuit malfunctions. Sometimes component malfunctions can easily be confused with circuit
malfunctions. Therefore, care must be exercised when isolating the cause of the problem. Example: A component may not operate before disconnecting an electrical connection, but it operates after reconnecting the connector. Reason: Oxidation of the terminals created High Resistance and a voltage drop that prevents the proper amount of current flow to the component. Disconnecting and reconnecting the connector, removed some oxidation and re-established good continuity through the connector.
RG40854,00000FD 1915JAN026/6
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-4
RG9894
UN06JAN99
PN=164
1. High Resistance Circuit: A High Resistance circuit can result in slow, dim or no component operation (for example: loose, corroded, dirty or oily terminals, gauge of wire too small or broken strands of wire). 2. Open Circuit: An Open circuit results in no component operation because the circuit is incomplete (for example: broken wire, terminals disconnected, open protective device or open switch). Do the following to isolate the location of a High Resistance or Open circuit: a. With the controlling switch (B) closed (on) and the load (I) connected into the circuit, check for
proper voltage at a location easily accessible between (C) and (H). If voltage is low, move toward the voltage source (A) to locate the point of voltage drop. If voltage is correct, move toward the load (I) and ground terminal (J) to locate the voltage drop.
04 160 5
NOTE: The example shows high resistance (D) between (C) and (E) and the open circuit (F) between (E) and (G).
b. Repair the circuit as required. c. Perform an operational check-out on the component after completing the repair.
RG40854,00000FE 1915JAN021/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-5
PN=165
Ground Circuit
AFuse A Terminal BFuse B Terminal CSwitch DComponent Terminal EWire Terminal FGrounded Circuit GComponent Terminal HLoad (Lamp)
3. Ground Circuit: A Grounded circuit (F) results in no component operation and the fuse or circuit breaker opens (for example: a power wire contacting the machine frame, chassis or component housing).
04 160 6
b. Disconnect the load (H) at component terminal (G). c. With the controlling switch (C) open (off), check for continuity to ground between (D) and (E). If there is continuity, there is a grounded circuit between (D) and (E). Repair the circuit.
Do the following to isolate the location of a Grounded circuit: a. Switch (C) must be open (off). Check for continuity to ground between (B) and (C). If there is continuity, there is a grounded circuit between (B) and (C). Repair the circuit. No continuity, go to step b.
RG40854,00000FE 1915JAN022/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-6
PN=166
Shorted Circuit
4. Shorted Circuit: Machines equipped with several electronic control devices contain wiring harnesses that can become shorted by one of the following ways shown above. 1. Battery wire from fuse (F1) is shorted at (A) to another battery wire after switch (Sw.2). Result: Lamp (E1) is on all of the time. 2. Battery wire from fuse (F1) is shorted at (B) to another battery wire after switches (Sw.1 & 2). Result: Both lamps (E1 & E2) operate on either switch (Sw. 1 or 2). 3. Battery wire from fuse (F1) is shorted at (C) to a ground wire. Result: Fuse (F1) opens after closing switch (Sw. 1) 4. Battery wire from switch (Sw. 2) is shorted at (D) to a regulated voltage wire. Result: The sensor signal voltage is distorted.1 5. Battery wire from switch (Sw. 2) is shorted at (E) to the sensor signal voltage wire. Result: The sensor signal is distorted.1 6. Battery wire from switch (Sw. 2) is shorted at (F) to the sensor ground wire.
Result: Fuse (F2) opens after closing switch (Sw. 2) and the sensor signal is distorted.1 7. Controller regulated voltage wire is shorted at (G) to the sensor signal voltage wire. Result: The sensor signal is distorted. 8. Controller regulated voltage wire is shorted at (H) to the sensor ground wire. Result: The sensor signal is distorted.1 9. Sensor voltage wire is shorted at (I) to the sensor ground wire. Result: The sensor signal is distorted.1 Do the following to isolate a Shorted Circuit: a. Review the machine electrical schematic to identify the circuits for the component that does not operate. b. Disconnect the components at each end of the circuits, to single out the affected wires. c. To prevent damage to connector terminals, obtain mating connector terminals from repair parts. DO NOT force meter probes into connector terminals.
RG9898
UN06JAN99
04 160 7
1 The sensor signal voltage goes out of range and a fault code may be restored. The controller may shut down or provide limited operation for its function.
RG40854,00000FE 1915JAN023/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-7
PN=167
04 160 8
RG40854,00000FE 1915JAN024/4
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-8
PN=168
04 160 9
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-9
PN=169
1. Scroll through the main menu of engine parameters by pressing either the right or the left touch switch 2. Select E-Config sub-menu by simultaneously pressing the right and the left touch switch. 3. Scroll through the E-Configsub-menu to view Engine Configuration Parameters by pressing either the right or the left touch switch until desired parameter is found. The numbers next to the parameters correspond to the number on the graph. 4. In order to exit E-Config sub-menu, simultaneously press the right and left touch switch
ADiagnostic Gauge BTouch Switches CLights
04 160 10
RG40854,00000FF 1915JAN021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-10
PN=170
RG10031
UN28OCT99
RG11647
Torque 1 Speed 2 Torque 2 Speed 3 Torque 3 Speed 4 Torque 4 Speed 5 Torque 5 Speed 6 Torque 6 Gov Gain Ref Torque
Speed 7
RPM
RG40854,00000FF 1915JAN022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-11
PN=171
04 160 12
RG40854,0000100 1915JAN021/1
DPSG,OUOD007,2842 1921OCT991/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-12
PN=172
RG10031
UN28OCT99
RG10031
UN28OCT99
NOTE: If the switches are held for less than 8 seconds, the sub menu will be exited.
5. If display reads ***********, press the right switch for at least 8 seconds.
NOTE: If the switch is held for less than 8 seconds, the sub menu will be exited.
6. If the display reads *Send* **DM3 *, the codes are now cleared. In order to exit StorCode sub menu, simultaneously press the right and left touch switch
RG40854,000006A 1923JAN011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-13
PN=173
RG10031
UN28OCT99
04 160 14
JDIS121 - ECU communication Hardware Kit is required to connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR to the ECU. Please refer to your John Deere Dealer website for obtaining the latest version of software. The diagnostic connector is a black, circular connector with a square mounting flange and a dust cap. There are nine available pins. Depending on application, the location of the diagnostic connector may vary. On OEM the connector is located near the ECU on the engine wiring harness. 1. Locate diagnostic connector on engine and remove dust cap.
2. Connect John Deere Controller Cable (B) to the diagnostic connector on the engine harness using the diagnostic connector mate (A). 3. Connect the other end of the John Deere Controller Cable (B) to the MagiKey (C) module at the 26 pin MagiKey connector (D). 4. Connect the PC cable (F) to the MagiKey (C) module at the 25 pin MagiKey connector (E). 5. Connect the PC cable (F) to the computer with the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DST) or SERVICE ADVISOR installed through the PC connector (G). 6. Key ON, engine off or running, verify that power light on MagiKey is illuminated green.
RG40854,0000101 1915JAN021/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-14
RG11737A
UN18MAY01
PN=174
RG40854,0000101 1915JAN022/2
Blinking DTCs
On OEM applications that have a Fault Lamp, the ECU has the ability to display DTCs using blinking sequence of the fault lamp. To retrieve DTCs from the ECU using the blink code method: 5. Following the active codes, the Fault Lamp will flash a code 33, this indicates the start of blinking stored codes. If there are any stored DTCs, the Fault Lamp will flash its 2digit number. If there is more than one stored DTC, the ECU will flash each code in numerical order. If there are no stored DTCs, the Fault Lamp will flash a code 88. 6. Once complete, the above sequence will be repeated. 7. When complete, turn ignition OFF As an example, if an engine had an active DTC 18 and stored DTC 53, the flashing sequence would be: flash flash flash flash flash flash flash flash three times...short pause two times...long pause one time...short pause eight times...long pause three times...short pause three times...long pause five times...short pause three times
04 160 15
NOTE: The ECU blinks the codes in 2-digit codes only. In order to convert the codes to SPN/FMI codes, see LISTING OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) ON ECU later in this Group.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON. 2. Hold Override Shutdown Switch for a few seconds 3. The Fault Lamp will begin to flash a code number. For example, flash three times...short pause...flash two times...long pause. This example is code 32. 4. The ECU begins the flashing sequence by flashing a code 32, this indicates the start of blinking active codes. If there are any active DTCs, the ECU will flash its 2digit number. If there is more than one active DTC, the ECU will flash each code in numerical order. If there are no active DTCs, the Fault Lamp will flash a code 88.
RG40854,0000102 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-15
PN=175
rpm N/A
a
ECU Boot Block Part Number ECU Configuration File Part Number ECU EOL Data Part Number
a
N/Aa N/A
a
N/Aa
RG40854,0000103 1915JAN021/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-16
PN=176
Description Part number for the Engine Control Unit (ECU) hardware. Serial number for the Engine Control Unit (ECU). Part number for the Engine Control Unit (ECU) software assembly. Part number for the Engine Control Unit (ECU) operating software. Engine Coolant Temperature value.
N/Aa N/A
a
N/Aa C (F)
NOTE: If there is an active fault for the ECT circuit, the ECT will be displayed as NA
Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Engine Hourmeter volts hr -minsec % N/Aa kPa (psi) N/Aa rpm N/Aa N/A
a
Engine Coolant Temperature sensor input voltage to the ECU Total hours the ECU has run on an engine.
Engine Load at Current Speed Engine Model Number Engine Oil Pressure Engine Serial Number Engine Speed Fuel Mode Fuel System Part Number Fuel System Serial Number Fuel Temperature
Percentage of load on the engine at a given speed. The model number for the engine. Engine Oil pressure value Serial number for the engine. The speed that the crank sensor detects the crank timing wheel to be moving at. This code explains the operation mode of the engine. The part number for the fuel system used on the engine. The serial number for the fuel system used on the engine. Fuel temperature value. NOTE: If there is an active fault for the fuel temperature circuit, the fuel temperature will be displayed as NA Fuel temperature sensor input voltage to the ECU. Total amount of fuel the ECU has commanded the pump control unit to deliver during the total hours shown by the Engine Hour Meter parameter. Manifold Air Temperature value. 04 160 17
Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Fuel Usage Rate Manifold Air Temperature
NOTE: If there is an active fault for the MAT circuit, MAT will be displayed as NA
a
RG40854,0000103 1915JAN022/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-17
PN=177
Oil Pressure
kPa (psi)
NOTE: If there is an active fault for the oil pressure circuit, the oil pressure will be displayed as NA
Oil Pressure Input Voltage Sensor Supply Voltage Throttle Type Throttle Position Torque Curve Number 04 160 18 volts volts N/Aa % N/Aa Oil Pressure sensor input voltage to the ECU Voltage that ECU supplies sensors on voltage supply #1 Type of throttle(s) active Percentage of throttle On some applications, the ECU limits the max fuel on multiple torque curves. This displays the torque curve the ECU is currently using to limit maximum fuel. See APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual and refer to the corresponding torque curve for your application.
RG40854,0000103 1915JAN023/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-18
PN=178
04 160 19
RG40854,0000171 1927FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-19
PN=179
04 160 20
RG40854,0000104 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-20
PN=180
04 160 21
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-21
PN=181
04 160 22
RG40854,0000106 1915JAN021/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-22
PN=182
RG40854,0000106 1915JAN022/5
04 160 23
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-23
PN=183
04 160 24
RG40854,0000106 1915JAN023/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-24
PN=184
620 100 620 100 100 105 105 105 110 110
4 1 3 3 4 3 4 16 0 3
04 160 25
620 629 637 637 100 639 F445 100 F446 100 F450 110 F455 110 F457 110 F459 1076 F460 105 1076 F461 1076 F462 1076 F463 1076 F464 1076 F465 105 1076 F470 174 F474 174 F475 174 1569 a N/A = Not Applicable
RG40854,0000106 1915JAN024/5
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-25
PN=185
2000 2000 637 637 1076 1076 1076 1076 1076 1076 1076 111 111 111 2000 629 158 2000
6 13 10 2 6 1 3 7 0 5 10 4 3 0 6 13 17 13
Internal ECU Failure Security Violation Crank Position Input Pattern Error Crank Position Input Noise Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short Pump Solenoid Current High Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long Pump Solenoid Circuit Open Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High Internal ECU Failure ECU Error ECU Power Down Error Security Violation
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-26
PN=186
Diagnostic Procedure
Diagnosis of the electronic control system should be performed according to the following procedure: 1. Make sure all engine mechanical and other systems not related to the electronic control system are operating properly. 2. Read and record DTC(s). If an SPN/FMI code is not used, convert the code to SPN/FMI. See LISTING OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) ON ECU earlier in this Group. 3. Go to the diagnostic procedure that corresponds to the DTC(s) present. 5. After any repairs are made, recheck to make sure all DTCs have been eliminated.
NOTE: After using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, always replace the dust cap on the diagnostic connector.
IMPORTANT: Care should be used during diagnostic procedures to avoid damaging the terminals of connectors, sensors, and actuators. Probes should not be poked into or around the terminals or damage will result. Probes should only be touched against the terminals to make measurements. It is recommended that JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit be used to make measurements in connectors, sensors, and actuators. These adapters will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: If more than one DTC is present, go to the chart corresponding to the lowest number DTC and diagnose that problem to correction unless directed to do otherwise.
4. If no DTC(s) are present, proceed to the appropriate symptom diagnostic chart in Group 150 of this Section.
04 160 27
RG40854,0000105 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-27
PN=187
04 160 28
RG40854,0000107 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-28
PN=188
Crawlers
04 160 29
Excavators
Forwarders
OEM
Analog Throttle (B) Input High Analog Throttle (A) Input High Analog Throttle (A) Input Low Multi-state Throttle Input High Multi-state Throttle Input Low
Skidders
T3 - Analog Throttle (A) Input High T4 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Low T22 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage Out of Range T1 - Multi-state Throttle Input High T2 - Multi-state Throttle Input Low T23 - Multi-state Throttle Input Voltage Out of Range T3 - Analog Throttle (A) Input High T4 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Low
Tele-handlers
91 - 3 - Throttle 1 91 - 4 - Throttle 1
RG40854,0000108 1915JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-29
PN=189
X J B G W K L C A F V U T S
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
S Sensor Ground
D3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
M D E N P R
S R
04 160 30
C O N N E C T O R
A B
A B
Low Idle High Idle Idle Switch JOHN DEERE Instrument Panel Multi-state Throttle Switch Multi-state throttle is composed of an idle switch that allows engine speed to be at high or low idle. On some applications, there is a bump up and a bump down feature. This allows for high and low idle to be controlled. On certain applications, an additional throttle is used in addition to the multi-state throttle. If the desired engine speed of the additional throttle is greater than the multi-state throttle, the multi-state throttle will be overridden. When the desired engine speed of the multi-state throttle is greater than the additional throttle, the multi-state throttle will be in total control. This code will set if: The multi-state throttle input voltage exceeds the maximum threshold. The voltage is higher than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the multi-state throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the multi-state throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
1914DEC01
RG40854,00000A2 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-30
PN=190
RG11976
RG40854,00000A1 1907DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T1 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector and the multi-state throttle connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 31
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T1 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs. 6. Ignition ON, engine OFF 7. Move the multi-state switch through all the positions. 8. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 91 FMI 3 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 3) reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 91 FMI 3 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 3) does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: Skidder applications use a different SPN for multi-state throttle than other applications.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-31
PN=191
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T1 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect multi-state throttle switch at two wire connector behind instrument panel. 3. Install a jumper wire between both terminals of the switch harness connector. 4. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine OFF 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 91 FMI 3 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 3) reoccurs: GO TO 4 SPN 91 FMI 4 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 3) occurs: Faulty multi-state throttle switch connector OR Faulty multi-state throttle switch
NOTE: Skidder applications use a different SPN for multi-state throttle than other applications.
04 160 32
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T1 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire. 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between multi-state switch 5 V input terminal and a good chassis ground.
Between 4.0 V and 6.0 V: Open in multi-state switch ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU Below 4.0 V: Open in multi-state switch 5 V input circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-32
PN=192
04 160 33
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-33
PN=193
X J B G W K L C A F V U T S
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
S Sensor Ground
D3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
M D E N P R
S R
04 160 34
C O N N E C T O R
A B
A B
Low Idle High Idle Idle Switch JOHN DEERE Instrument Panel Multi-state Throttle Switch Multi-state throttle is composed of an idle switch that allows engine speed to be at high or low idle. On some applications, there is a bump up and a bump down feature. This allows for high and low idle to be controlled. On certain applications, an additional throttle is used in addition to the multi-state throttle. If the desired engine speed of the additional throttle is greater than the multi-state throttle, the multi-state throttle will be overridden. When the desired engine speed of the multi-state throttle is greater than the additional throttle, the multi-state throttle will be in total control. This code will set if: The multi-state throttle input voltage drops below the minimum threshold. The voltage is lower than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the multi-state throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the multi-state throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
1914DEC01
RG40854,00000A0 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-34
PN=194
RG11976
RG40854,00000A3 1911DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T2 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector and the multi-state throttle connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 35
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T2 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs. 6. Ignition ON, engine OFF 7. Move the multi-state switch through all the positions. 8. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 91 FMI 4 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 4) reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 91 FMI 4 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 4) does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: Skidder applications use a different SPN for multi-state throttle than other applications.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-35
PN=195
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T2 - MULTI-STATE THROTTLE INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect multi-state throttle switch at two wire connector behind instrument panel. 3. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine OFF 6. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 91 FMI 4 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 4) reoccurs: Short to ground in multi-state input circuit OR Open in multi-state input circuit OR Faulty ECU SPN 91 FMI 3 (Skidders: SPN 29 FMI 3) occurs: Faulty multi-state throttle switch connector OR Faulty multi-state throttle switch.
NOTE: Skidder applications use a different SPN for multi-state throttle than other applications.
04 160 36
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-36
PN=196
04 160 37
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-37
PN=197
J K L M N C
X B G W A F V E S U T R
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
C L
D3 E1 E2
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
D P
M Sensor 5V
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3
CLM
04 160 38
J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
C O N N E C T O R
A B C
A B C
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For non-OEM engine wiring information, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Analog Throttle Position Sensor The analog throttle position sensor is a variable resistor (potentiometer) used to measure the position of the throttle. The throttle input voltage normally varies between 1.0 and 4.0 volts depending on throttle position. Analog throttle voltage at low idle will be approximately 1.0 volt and 4.0 volts at high idle. The ECU has the ability to learn different voltages for low and high idle, so the voltage range may change per application. This code will set if:
The analog throttle (A) input voltage exceeds the sensors high voltage specification. The voltage is higher than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 4.7 volts. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high analog throttle (A) input voltage specification. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the analog throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the analog throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,000009E 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-38
PN=198
RG11974
RG40854,00000A4 1911DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T3 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog (A) throttle connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 39
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T3 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Analog Throttle (A) in the idle position. 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. SERVICE ADVISOR is a trademark of Deere & Company
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-39
PN=199
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T3 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
While slowly operating analog throttle (A) through its full travel, use the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR for the following: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
Goes above 4.7 V: Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor connector OR Open in analog throttle (A) sensor ground circuit OR Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor Never goes above 4.7 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 40
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T3 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect analog throttle (A) sensor connector behind instrument panel. 3. Ignition ON, Engine OFF 4. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
0.3 V or less: GO TO 5 Above 0.3 V: Short to voltage in analog throttle (A) input circuit OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T3 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Analog throttle (A) sensor connector still disconnected. 3. Using a test light connected to battery (+), probe the ground terminal in throttle (A) sensor harness connector.
Light ON: Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor connector OR Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor Light OFF: Open in analog throttle (A) ground circuit
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-40
PN=200
04 160 41
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-41
PN=201
J K L M N C
X B G W A F V E S U T R
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
C L
D3 E1 E2
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
D P
M Sensor 5V
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3
CLM
04 160 42
J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
C O N N E C T O R
A B C
A B C
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For non-OEM engine wiring information, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Analog Throttle Position Sensor The analog throttle position sensor is a variable resistor (potentiometer) used to measure the position of the throttle. The throttle input voltage normally varies between 1.0 and 4.0 volts depending on throttle position. Analog throttle voltage at low idle will be approximately 1.0 volt and 4.0 volts at high idle. The ECU has the ability to learn different voltages for low and high idle, so the voltage range may change per application. This code will set if:
The analog throttle (A) input voltage goes below the sensors low voltage specification. The voltage is lower than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 0.3 volts. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the low analog throttle (A) input voltage specification. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the analog throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the analog throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,000009C 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-42
PN=202
RG11974
RG40854,00000A5 1913DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T4 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog (A) throttle connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 43
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T4 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Throttle (A) in the idle position. 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. SERVICE ADVISOR is a trademark of Deere & Company
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-43
PN=203
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T4 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT LOW supporting information.
While slowly operating analog throttle (A) through its full travel, use the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR for the following: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
Goes below 0.3 V: Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor connector OR Open in analog throttle (A) sensor ground circuit OR Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor Never goes above 0.3 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 44
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T4 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect analog throttle (A) sensor connector. 3. Install a jumper wire between the 5 V Supply terminal and the input terminal in the harness side of the sensor connector. 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage
Below 4.7 V: GO TO 5 4.7 V or greater: Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor connector OR Faulty analog throttle (A) sensor
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (A) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-44
PN=204
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T4 - ANALOG THROTTLE (A) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire. 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between the analog throttle (A) ground terminal and the 5 V Supply terminal in the sensor harness connector.
Between 4.0 V and 6.0 V: Open in analog throttle (A) input circuit OR Short to ground in analog throttle (A) input circuit OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Below 4.0 V: Open in analog throttle (A) 5 V Supply circuit OR Short to ground in analog throttle (A) 5 V Supply circuit 04 OR 160 Faulty ECU connector 45 OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-45
PN=205
D3
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3
C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
Throttle Emulator A B
04 160 46
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For non-OEM engine wiring information, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Analog Throttle Position Sensor The analog throttle position sensor is a variable resistor (potentiometer) used to measure the position of the throttle. The throttle input voltage normally varies between 1.0 and 4.0 volts depending on throttle position. Analog throttle voltage at low idle will be approximately 1.0 volt and 4.0 volts at high idle. The ECU has the ability to learn different voltages for low and high idle, so the voltage range may change per application. This code will set if:
The analog throttle (B) input voltage exceeds the sensors high voltage specification. The voltage is higher than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 4.7 volts. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high analog throttle (B) input voltage specification. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the analog throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the analog throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,000009A 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-46
PN=206
RG11975
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
RG40854,00000A6 1913DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T5 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog (B) throttle connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 47
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T5 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Analog Throttle (B) in the idle position. 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. SERVICE ADVISOR is a trademark of Deere & Company
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-47
PN=207
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T5 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
While slowly operating analog throttle (B) through its full travel, use the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR for the following: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
Goes above 4.7 V: Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor connector OR Open in analog throttle (B) sensor ground circuit OR Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor Never goes above 4.7 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 48
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T5 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect analog throttle (B) sensor connector behind instrument panel. 3. Ignition ON, Engine OFF 4. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
0.3 V or less: GO TO 5 Above 0.3 V: Short to voltage in analog throttle (B) input circuit OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T5 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Analog throttle (B) sensor connector disconnected. 3. Using a test light connected to battery (+), probe the ground terminal in throttle (B) sensor harness connector.
Light ON: Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor connector OR Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor Light OFF: Open in analog throttle (B) ground circuit
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-48
PN=208
04 160 49
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-49
PN=209
D3
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3
C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
Throttle Emulator A B
04 160 50
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For non-OEM engine wiring information, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Analog Throttle Position Sensor The analog throttle position sensor is a variable resistor (potentiometer) used to measure the position of the throttle. The throttle input voltage normally varies between 1.0 and 4.0 volts depending on throttle position. Analog throttle voltage at low idle will be approximately 1.0 volt and 4.0 volts at high idle. The ECU has the ability to learn different voltages for low and high idle, so the voltage range may change per application. This code will set if:
The analog throttle (B) input voltage goes below the sensors low voltage specification. The voltage is lower than what is physically possible for the throttle lever to achieve. For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 0.3 volts. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the low analog throttle (B) input voltage specification. If this code sets, the following will occur: If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the analog throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the analog throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,0000098 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-50
PN=210
RG11975
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
RG40854,00000A7 1913DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog (B) throttle connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 51
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Analog Throttle (B) in the idle position. 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. SERVICE ADVISOR is a trademark of Deere & Company
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-51
PN=211
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW supporting information.
While slowly operating analog throttle (B) through its full travel, use the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR for the following: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
Goes below 0.3 V: Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor connector OR Open in analog throttle (B) sensor ground circuit OR Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor Never goes above 0.3 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group
04 160 52
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect analog throttle (B) sensor connector. 3. Install a jumper wire between the 5 V Supply terminal and the input terminal in the harness side of the sensor connector. 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR: For OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage (OEM) For non-OEM applications, read Analog Throttle (B) Input Voltage
Below 4.7 V: GO TO 5 4.7 V or greater: Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor connector OR Faulty analog throttle (B) sensor
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high analog throttle (B) input voltage specification is 4.7V. For the high voltage specification on non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-52
PN=212
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T6 - ANALOG THROTTLE (B) INPUT LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire. 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage between the analog throttle (B) ground terminal and the 5 V Supply terminal in the sensor harness connector.
Between 4.0 V and 6.0 V: Open in analog throttle (B) input circuit OR Short to ground in analog throttle (B) input circuit OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Below 4.0 V: Open in analog throttle (B) 5 V Supply circuit OR Short to ground in analog throttle (B) 5 V Supply circuit 04 OR 160 Faulty ECU connector 53 OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-53
PN=213
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
E F G
04 160 54
D C A J H B
D C E B A
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3
C O N N E C T O R
K1 K2 K3
Diagnostic Connector
C C CAN Terminator CAN (Controller Area Network) Throttle CAN (Controller Area Network) throttle is information sent to the ECU by another controller over CAN of the desired throttle position. This code will set if: The ECU either does not receive throttle information over CAN, or the information received is not valid. If this code sets, the following will occur:
If more than one throttle is available, the ECU will ignore the input from the CAN throttle, and will use the input values from another throttle. If the CAN throttle is the only throttle or all additional throttles are also faulted, the ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,0000096 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-54
PN=214
RG11972
1914DEC01
B B A C
RG40854,00000A8 1913DEC011/1
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T7 - CAN THROTTLE INVALID supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector and any connectors associated with the CAN throttle. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 55
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T7 - CAN THROTTLE INVALID supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs. 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 91 FMI 9 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 91 FMI 9 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-55
PN=215
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T7 - CAN THROTTLE INVALID supporting information.
If application has other machine controllers communicating on the CAN bus, check those controllers for CAN related DTCs.
No CAN related DTCs found on other controllers: GO TO 4 Found CAN related DTCs found on other controllers: Refer to diagnostic procedure for that controller.
1/1
04 160 56
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T7 - CAN THROTTLE INVALID supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminals C and D in the harness end of the diagnostic connector.
Between 45-75 ohms: GO TO 5 Less than 45 or greater than 75 ohms: Faulty or missing CAN terminator connector(s) OR Open or short in CAN wiring harness.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T7 - CAN THROTTLE INVALID supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between a good chassis ground and: Terminal C in the diagnostic connector. Terminal D in the diagnostic connector.
Both measurements between 1.5 V and 3.5 V: Faulty ECU connector OR Other connector in the CAN system OR Faulty ECU. Either measurement less than 1.5 V or greater than 3.5 V: CAN wiring shorted to ground or voltage OR Another controller in the CAN system is faulty OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-56
PN=216
04 160 57
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-57
PN=217
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 58
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle reference voltage to the ECU exceeds 4.2 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will default excavator reference throttle voltage to 3.75 volts.
RG40854,0000094 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-58
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=218
RG40854,00000A9 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T11 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T11 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 59
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T11 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 28 FMI 3 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 28 FMI 3 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 28 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: If DTCs SPN 29 FMI 3 or SPN 29 FMI 4 are active, follow those DTCs first.
6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-59
PN=219
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T11 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector. 3. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between terminal F3 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the ground stud of the Pump and Valve controller.
3.95 V or less: GO TO 4 Greater than 3.95 V: Short to power in throttle reference wire OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller connector OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T11 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
There is a difference between grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connections at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-60
PN=220
04 160 61
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-61
PN=221
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 62
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle reference voltage to the ECU goes below 2.7 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will default excavator reference throttle voltage to 3.75 volts.
RG40854,0000092 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-62
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=222
RG40854,0000091 1907DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T12 - Excavator Throttle Reference Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T12 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 63
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T12 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs.
SPN 28 FMI 4 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 28 FMI 4 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 28 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: If DTCs SPN 29 FMI 3 or SPN 29 FMI 4 are active, follow those DTCs first.
6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-63
PN=223
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T12 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between terminal F3 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the ground stud of the Pump and Valve controller.
3.55 V or greater: GO TO 4 Less than 3.55 V: Open in throttle reference wire OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller connector OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T12 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE REFERENCE VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
There is a difference between the grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connections at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-64
PN=224
04 160 65
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-65
PN=225
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 66
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle ground voltage to the ECU exceeds 3.0 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will default excavator throttle ground voltage to 0 volts.
RG40854,0000090 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-66
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=226
RG40854,00000AA 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T13 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T13 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 67
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T13 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs. 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
SPN 29 FMI 3 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 29 FMI 3 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 29 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-67
PN=227
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T13 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Disconnect Pump and Valve controller connector. 4. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal C1 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the corresponding ground terminal of the Pump and Valve controller connector.
770 ohms or less: GO TO 4 Greater than 770 ohms: Short to power in throttle ground wire between ECU and 750 ohm resistor OR Open in throttle ground wire OR Faulty 750 ohm resistor OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU
04 160 68
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T13 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. ECU connector still disconnected. 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal C1 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the ground stud of the Pump and Valve controller.
770 ohms or less: GO TO 5 Greater than 770 ohms: Faulty Pump and Valve controller connector OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller
1/1
5 Ground Test
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T13 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
There is a difference between grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connection at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-68
PN=228
04 160 69
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-69
PN=229
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 70
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle ground voltage to the ECU goes below 2.0 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will default excavator throttle ground voltage to 0 volts.
RG40854,000008E 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-70
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=230
RG40854,00000AB 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T14 - Excavator Throttle Ground Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T14 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 71
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T14 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs. 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
SPN 29 FMI 4 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 29 FMI 4 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 29 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-71
PN=231
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T14 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal C1 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the corresponding ground terminal of the Pump and Valve controller connector.
730 ohms or greater: GO TO 4 Less than 730 ohms: Short to ground in throttle ground wire between ECU and resistor OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T14 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE GROUND VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
There is a difference between grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connection at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-72
PN=232
04 160 73
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-73
PN=233
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 74
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle input voltage to the ECU exceeds 4.9 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,0000089 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-74
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=234
RG40854,00000AC 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T15 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T15 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 75
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T15 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs.
SPN 91 FMI 3 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 91 FMI 3 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 91 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: If DTCs SPN 29 FMI 3 or SPN 29 FMI 4 are active, follow those DTCs first.
6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-75
PN=235
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T15 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between terminal B3 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the ground pin of the Pump and Valve controller.
4.0 V or less: GO TO 4 Greater than 4.0 V: Short to power in throttle signal wire OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller connector OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T15 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
There is a difference between grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connection at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-76
PN=236
04 160 77
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-77
PN=237
F3 B3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3
Throttle Ground
C1
G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 78
Excavator Throttle The Excavator uses an analog throttle to measure throttle position. This throttle is connected to the Pump and Valve controller, which sends throttle input information to the ECU through a dedicated wire. Since the ECU and Pump and Valve controller do not share a common ground, a throttle voltage reference wire and a throttle ground wire accompany the throttle input wire. The ECU calculates the differences in controller grounds in order to determine the throttle request by the Pump and Valve controller.
This code will set if: The excavator throttle input voltage to the ECU goes below 0.1 volts. If this code sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use a default limp-home throttle value that will only allow idle engine speed.
RG40854,000008B 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-78
RG11977
1914DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=238
RG40854,00000AD 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - T16 - Excavator Throttle Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
NOTE: This diagnostic procedure is only used to diagnose the Excavator Throttle.
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T16 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, throttle sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 79
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T16 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs
SPN 91 FMI 4 reoccurs when engine is off and running: GO TO 3 SPN 91 FMI 4 reoccurs only when engine is running: GO TO 4 SPN 91 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: If DTCs SPN 29 FMI 3 or SPN 29 FMI 4 are active, follow those DTCs first.
6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. Ignition ON, engine OFF Ignition ON, engine running
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-79
PN=239
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T16 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between terminal B3 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the ground pin of the Pump and Valve controller.
1.0 V or greater: GO TO 4 Less than 1.0 V: Open in throttle signal wire OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller connector OR Faulty Pump and Valve controller
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation, see T16 - EXCAVATOR THROTTLE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
There is a difference between grounds of the ECU and Pump and Valve controller. Check for loose ground connection at each controller.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-80
PN=240
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-81
PN=241
Level 12 ECU - T20 - Throttle Input Voltage Below Lower Calibration Limit
Throttle Calibration Throttle calibration is necessary to allow the ECU to learn the range of the throttle. It is performed when a new ECU or a new throttle has been installed. This code will set if: The ECU detects a throttle input voltage lower than the defined low calibration limit. If this code sets, the following will occur:
04 160 82
If this code sets: Diagnose other DTCs first. If no other DTCs are found, perform throttle sensor diagnostics. For 310G Backhoe Loaders, see THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST (S.N. XXXXXX ) in Section 9015, Group 120 of TM1885. For 310SG/315SG Backhoe Loaders, see THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST (S.N. XXXXXX ) in Section 9015, Group 120 of TM1883.
RG40854,000011F 1928JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-82
PN=242
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-83
PN=243
Level 12 ECU - T22 - Analog Throttle (A) Input Voltage Out of Range
Analog Throttle Sensor The analog throttle position sensor is a variable resistor (potentiometer) used to measure the position of the throttle. The throttle input voltage normally varies between 1.0 and 4.0 volts depending on throttle position. Analog throttle voltage at low idle will be approximately 1.0 volt and 4.0 volts at high idle. The ECU has the ability to learn different voltages for low and high idle, so the voltage range may change per application. This code will set if:
04 160 84
For engine with multiple throttles, the ECU will not read the input of the faulty throttle, so the ECU run entirely off of the other throttle. If this code sets: Diagnose other DTCs first. If no other DTCs are found, perform throttle sensor diagnostics. For 310G Backhoe Loaders, see THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST (S.N. XXXXXX ) in Section 9015, Group 120 of TM1885. For 310SG/315SG Backhoe Loaders, see THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST (S.N. XXXXXX ) in Section 9015, Group 120 of TM1883. Check for other throttle DTCs. Diagnose those first. Return throttle to 0% throttle position Some applications require key OFF/restart cycle to clear the code.
The ECU detects a high or low out of range analog throttle (A) input voltage. If this code sets, the following will occur: For engines with only one throttle, the ECU will not read the input of the throttle and run the engine at low idle.
RG40854,000011D 1928JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-84
PN=244
04 160 85
RG40854,000011C 1928JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-85
PN=245
RG40854,0000002 1912MAR021/1
04 160 86
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-86
PN=246
04 160 87
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-87
PN=247
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
Oil Pressure Sensor B C A
A C B B A C
Oil Pressure Sensor Connector B 5V Supply C Oil Pressure Input A Sensor Ground D3 F3 E2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11978
040902
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2
04 160 88
A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
NOTE: Wiring schematics show OEM engine applications for the oil pressure sensor and Telehandler applications for the oil pressure switch. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Oil Pressure Sensor or Switch The oil pressure sensor is a pressure transducer connected to the main oil galley. As engine oil pressure increases, the oil pressure sensor input voltage increases. The ECU monitors oil pressure in order to protect the engine in case of a low oil pressure condition. For further oil pressure sensor information, see MEASURING PRESSURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual.
The oil pressure switch is used to detect a loss of oil pressure. Oil pressure causes the contacts in the switch close when oil pressure drops below the minimum oil pressure threshold. The switch is open when the engine is not running and engine is running with sufficient oil pressure. DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 will set if: For engines with an oil pressure sensor, the ECU senses an extremely low oil pressure. For engines with an oil pressure switch, the ECU sensses the oil pressure switch is open after the engine is above cranking RPM for several seconds. If DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 sets, the following will occur:
RG40854,0000088 1907DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-88
RG12045
C O N N E C T O R
1920DEC01
RG40854,0000088 1907DEC012/2
04 160 89
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-89
PN=249
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low - Continued
RG40854,00000B2 1913DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE EXTREMELY LOW supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the oil pressure sensor, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE EXTREMELY LOW supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 occurs, measure engine oil pressure. See CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
Oil pressure within specification: Verify that oil pressure sensor or switch circuits is OK. If oil pressure sensor or switch circuits are OK, replace oil pressure sensor or switch and retest. Oil pressure below specification: Low oil pressure problem. See 4.5L/6.8L - L2 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE LOW in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L and 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-90
PN=250
04 160 91
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-91
PN=251
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage High
Oil Pressure Sensor B C A
A C B B A C
Oil Pressure Sensor Connector B 5V Supply C Oil Pressure Input A Sensor Ground D3 F3 E2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11978
040902
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2
04 160 92
A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Oil Pressure Sensor The oil pressure sensor is a pressure transducer connected to the main oil galley. As engine oil pressure increases, the oil pressure sensor input voltage increases. The ECU monitors oil pressure in order to protect the engine in case of a low oil pressure condition. For further oil pressure sensor information, see MEASURING PRESSURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 will set if:
The oil pressure input voltage exceeds the sensors high voltage specification. The voltage is higher than what is physically possible for oil pressure. For OEM applications, the high oil pressure input voltage specification is 4.5 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high oil pressure input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: ECU uses a default oil pressure of 260 kPa (2.6 bar) (37.5 bar). ECUs low oil pressure engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,0000086 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-92
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage High - Continued
RG40854,00000B3 1914DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the oil pressure sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 93
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read Oil Pressure Input Voltage using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
4.5 V or greater: GO TO 3 Below 4.5 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high oil pressure input voltage specification is 4.5V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-93
PN=253
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect oil pressure sensor connector 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Read Oil Pressure Input Voltage using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
0.3 V or below: GO TO 4 Above 0.3 V: Short to voltage in oil pressure sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low oil pressure input voltage specification is 0.3V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
04 160 94
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
Probe oil pressure sensor ground (Terminal A) in sensor harness connector with a test light connected to battery voltage.
Light ON: Faulty oil pressure sensor OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU Light OFF: Open in oil pressure sensor ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-94
PN=254
04 160 95
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-95
PN=255
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage Low
Oil Pressure Sensor B C A
A C B B A C
Oil Pressure Sensor Connector B 5V Supply C Oil Pressure Input A Sensor Ground D3 F3 E2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11978
040902
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2
04 160 96
A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
NOTE: Wiring schematics show OEM engine applications for the oil pressure sensor and Telehandler applications for the oil pressure switch. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Oil Pressure Sensor or Switch The oil pressure sensor is a pressure transducer connected to the main oil galley. As engine oil pressure increases, the oil pressure sensor input voltage increases. The ECU monitors oil pressure in order to protect the engine in case of a low oil pressure condition. For further oil pressure sensor information, see MEASURING PRESSURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual.
The oil pressure switch is used to detect a loss of oil pressure. A lack of oil pressure causes the contacts in the switch close when oil pressure drops below the minimum oil pressure threshold. The switch is open when the engine is not running and engine is running with sufficient oil pressure. DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 will set if: For oil pressure sensors, the oil pressure input voltage drops below the sensors low voltage specification. The voltage is lower than what is physically possible for oil pressure. For OEM applications, the low oil pressure input voltage specification is 0.3 volts.
RG40854,0000084 1907DEC011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-96
RG12045
C O N N E C T O R
1920DEC01
RG40854,0000084 1907DEC012/2
04 160 97
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-97
PN=257
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage Low - Continued
RG40854,00000B4 1914DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 Engine Oil Pressure Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the oil pressure sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 100 FMI 4 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 100 FMI 4 doesnt reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-98
PN=258
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Determine whether an oil pressure sensor or an oil pressure switch is being used.
Oil pressure sensor being used: GO TO 4 Oil pressure switch being used: GO TO 6
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect oil pressure sensor connector 3. Install a jumper wire between oil pressure 5 V supply and oil pressure input in harness sensor connector 4. Read the Oil Pressure Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Below 4.5 V: GO TO 5
04 160 4.5 V or greater: 99 Faulty oil pressure sensor connector OR Faulty oil pressure sensor
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high oil pressure input voltage specification is 4.5V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between oil pressure 5 V supply terminal and a good chassis ground
Between 4.0 V and 6.0 V: Open in oil pressure input circuit OR Short to ground in oil pressure input circuit OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Below 4.0 V: Open in oil pressure 5 V supply circuit OR Short to ground in oil pressure 5 V supply circuit OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-99
PN=259
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 4 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect oil pressure switch connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure the resistance between terminal C1 in the ECU and: All other terminals in the ECU connector A good ground
All measurements greater than 2000 ohms: Faulty oil pressure switch OR Faulty ECU Any measurement less than 2000 ohms: Short in oil pressure input circuit
1/1
04 160 ,100
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-100
PN=260
04 160 ,101
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-101
PN=261
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 Engine Oil Pressure Moderately Low
Oil Pressure Sensor B C A
A C B B A C
Oil Pressure Sensor Connector B 5V Supply C Oil Pressure Input A Sensor Ground D3 F3 E2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11978
040902
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2
04 160 ,102
A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Oil Pressure Sensor The oil pressure sensor is a pressure transducer connected to the main oil galley. As engine oil pressure increases, the oil pressure sensor input voltage increases. The ECU monitors oil pressure in order to protect the engine in case of a low oil pressure condition. For further oil pressure sensor information, see MEASURING PRESSURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 will set if:
For engines with an oil pressure sensor, the ECU senses a moderately low oil pressure. If DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: No shutdown available for this code. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 40% per minute until the engine is running at 60% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,0000082 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-102
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 Engine Oil Pressure Moderately Low - Continued
RG40854,00000B5 1914DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 Engine Oil Pressure Moderately Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE MODERATELY LOW supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the oil pressure sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,103
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE MODERATELY LOW supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 occurs, measure engine oil pressure. CHECK ENGINE OIL PRESSURE in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
Oil pressure within specification: Low oil pressure problem. See 4.5L/6.8L - L2 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE LOW in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L and 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). Oil pressure below specification: Verify that oil pressure sensor 5 V supply, input, and ground circuits are OK. If oil pressure sensor circuits are OK, replace oil pressure sensor and retest.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-103
PN=263
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage High
MAT Sensor MAT Sensor Connector B A B A Sensor Ground MAT Input
D1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11979
04 160 ,104
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
MAT (Manifold Air Temperature) Sensor The MAT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the intake manifold. The MAT sensor is used to measure the temperature of the intake air. The MAT sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher intake air temperatures result in lower MAT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further MAT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140. DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 will set if:
The manifold air temperture input voltage exceeds the sensors high voltage specification. The voltage is higher than what is physically possible for manifold air. For OEM applications, the high manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 4.9 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high manifold air temperature specification. If DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: ECU uses a default MAT value of 60C (140F). ECUs high manifold air temperature engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,0000080 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-104
PN=264
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage High Continued
RG40854,00000B6 1918DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the manifold air temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,105
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
4.9 V or greater: GO TO 3 Below 4.9 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: For OEM applications, the high manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 4.9V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-105
PN=265
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect MAT sensor connector 3. Install a jumper wire between both terminals in the MAT sensor harness connector 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: GO TO 4 0.1 V or below: Faulty MAT sensor connector OR Faulty MAT sensor
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 0.1V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,106
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 3 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire between both terminals. 3. Install jumper wire between MAT sensor harness connector input terminal and a good chassis ground. 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: Open in MAT sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU 0.1 V or below: Open in MAT sensor ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: For OEM applications, the low manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 0.1V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-106
PN=266
04 160 ,107
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-107
PN=267
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage Low
MAT Sensor MAT Sensor Connector B A B A Sensor Ground MAT Input
D1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11979
04 160 ,108
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
MAT (Manifold Air Temperature) Sensor The MAT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the intake manifold. The MAT sensor is used to measure the temperature of the intake air. The MAT sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher intake air temperatures result in lower MAT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further MAT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140. DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 will set if:
The manifold air temperature input voltage goes below the sensors low voltage specification. The voltage is lower than what is physically possible manifold air temperature to achieve. For OEM engine applications, the low manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 0.1 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the low manifold temperature input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: ECU uses a default MAT value of 60C (140F) to run engine. ECUs high manifold air temperature engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,000007D 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-108
PN=268
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage Low Continued
RG40854,00000B7 1918DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the manifold air temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,109
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
0.1 V or below: GO TO 3 Above 0.1 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the low manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 0.1V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-109
PN=269
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 4 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect MAT sensor connector. 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Read the Manifold Air Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Below 4.9 V: Short to ground in MAT sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU 4.9 V or greater: Faulty MAT sensor connector OR Faulty MAT sensor
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the high manifold air temperature input voltage specification is 4.9V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,110
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-110
PN=270
04 160 ,111
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-111
PN=271
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 Manifold Air Temperature Moderately High
MAT Sensor MAT Sensor Connector B A B A Sensor Ground MAT Input
D1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11979
04 160 ,112
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
MAT (Manifold Air Temperature) Sensor The MAT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the intake manifold. The MAT sensor is used to measure the temperature of the intake air. The MAT sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher intake air temperatures result in lower MAT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further MAT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140. DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 will set if:
The ECU senses MAT on OEM applications above 100C (212F) for H engines and 120C (248F) for T engines. For MAT specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. If DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: The ECU does not use shutdown feature with this code. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 2% per minute until the engine is running at 80% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,000007B 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-112
PN=272
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 Manifold Air Temperature Moderately High Continued
RG40854,00000B8 1918DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 Manifold Air Temperature Moderately High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE MODERATELY HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the manifold air temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,113
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 105 FMI 16 MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE MODERATELY HIGH supporting information.
Check the following items that can cause high intake air temperatures: Excessively high ambient air temperature. Restricted, dirty, or damaged charge air cooler. Loose cooling fan belt. Malfunctioning cooling fan. Restricted or damaged intake air piping. Damaged cooling fan shroud.
Cause of high MAT located: Repair problem and retest. No cause of high MAT located: Verify that MAT sensor input and ground circuits are OK. If MAT sensor circuits are OK, replace MAT sensor and retest.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-113
PN=273
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 Engine Coolant Temperature High Most Severe
ECT Sensor t ECT Sensor Connector ECT Ground
B A B A
ECT Input B1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11980
04 160 ,114
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor The ECT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted on the thermostat housing or in the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature. The ECTs variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower ECT input voltages to the Engine Control Unit (ECU); lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further ECT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 will set if:
The ECU senses ECT on OEM applications above 118C (244F). For the most severe ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: The derate feature will go into effect when the code is set, and the engine will shut down after 30 seconds. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 60% per minute until the engine is running at 40% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,0000071 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-114
PN=274
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 Engine Coolant Temperature High Most Severe Continued
RG40854,00000B9 1918DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 Engine Coolant Temperature High Most Severe Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH MOST SEVERE supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,115
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH MOST SEVERE supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 occurs, use a temperature gauge and verify that engine coolant temperature is above the most severe ECT specification.
NOTE: On OEM applications, the most severe ECT specification is 118C(244F). For the most severe ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
ECT 118C (244F) or above: Engine overheating problem. See 4.5L/6.8L C1 - ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE ABOVE NORMAL in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). ECT significantly less than 118C (244F): Verify that ECT input and ground circuits are OK If both circuits are OK, replace ECT sensor and retest
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-115
PN=275
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High
ECT Sensor t ECT Sensor Connector ECT Ground
B A B A
ECT Input B1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11980
04 160 ,116
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor The ECT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted on the thermostat housing or in the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature. The ECTs variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower ECT input voltages to the Engine Control Unit (ECU); lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further ECT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 will set if:
The ECT input voltage goes above the sensors high voltage specification. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is lower than what is physically possible for engine coolant. For OEM engine applications, the high ECT input voltage specification is 4.9 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high ECT input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: When in start mode, the ECU will default the ECT to -30C (-22F). When in running mode, the ECU will default the ECT to 90C (194F). ECUs high ECT engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,0000072 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-116
PN=276
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Continued
RG40854,00000BA 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,117
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine running 5. Read the Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage parameter using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
At or above 4.9 V: GO TO 3 Below 4.9 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
NOTE: On OEM applications, the high ECT input voltage specification is 4.9V. For high input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-117
PN=277
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECT sensor connector 3. Install a jumper wire between both terminals in the ECT sensor harness connector 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: GO TO 4 At or below 0.1 V: Faulty ECT sensor connector OR Faulty ECT sensor
NOTE: On OEM applications, the low ECT input voltage specification is 0.1 volts and below. For ECT input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,118
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 3 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire between both terminals 3. Install jumper wire between ECT sensor harness connector input terminal and a good chassis ground 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: Open in ECT input sensor circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU 0.1 V or below: Open in ECT sensor ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: On OEM applications, the low ECT input voltage specification is 0.1 volts and below. For ECT input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-118
PN=278
04 160 ,119
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-119
PN=279
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low
ECT Sensor t ECT Sensor Connector ECT Ground
B A B A
ECT Input B1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11980
04 160 ,120
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor The ECT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted on the thermostat housing. It is used to measure the coolant temperature. The ECTs variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower ECT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further ECT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 will set if:
The ECT input voltage goes below the sensors low voltage specification. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is higher than what is physically possible for engine coolant. For OEM engine applications, the low ECT input voltage specification is 0.1 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high ECT input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: When in start mode, the ECU will default the ECT to -30C (-22F). When in running mode, the ECU will default the ECT to 90C (194F). ECUs high ECT engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,0000074 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-120
PN=280
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Continued
RG40854,00000BB 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,121
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage parameter using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
0.1 V or below: GO TO 3 Above 0.1 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the low ECT input voltage specification is 0.1V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-121
PN=281
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 4 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECT sensor connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Read the Engine Coolant Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Below 4.9 V: Short to ground in ECT sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU 4.9 V or greater: Faulty ECT sensor
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the high ECT input voltage specification is 4.9V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,122
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-122
PN=282
04 160 ,123
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-123
PN=283
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 Engine Coolant Temperature High Least Severe
ECT Sensor t ECT Sensor Connector ECT Ground
B A B A
ECT Input B1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11980
04 160 ,124
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor The ECT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted on the thermostat housing or at the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature. The ECTs variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower ECT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further ECT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 will set if:
The ECU senses ECT on OEM applications above 108C (226F). For the least severe ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: No shutdown available for this code. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 2% per minute until the engine is running at 95% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,0000076 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-124
PN=284
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 Engine Coolant Temperature High Least Severe Continued
RG40854,00000BC 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 Engine Coolant Temperature High Least Severe Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH LEAST SEVERE supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,125
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH LEAST SEVERE supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 110 FMI 15 occurs, using a temperature gauge, verify that engine coolant temperature is above the least severe ECT specification.
ECT above 108C (226F): Engine overheating problem. See 4.5L/6.8L C1 - ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE ABOVE NORMAL in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). ECT significantly less than 108C (226F): Verify that ECT sensor input and ground circuits are OK. If ECT sensor circuits are OK, replace ECT sensor and retest
NOTE: On OEM applications, the least servere ECT specification is 108C (226F). For the least severe ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-125
PN=285
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 Engine Coolant Temperature High Moderately Severe
ECT Sensor t ECT Sensor Connector ECT Ground
B A B A
ECT Input B1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11980
04 160 ,126
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor The ECT sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted on the thermostat housing or at the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature. The ECTs variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower ECT input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further ECT sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 will set if:
The ECU senses ECT on OEM applications above 113C (235F). For the moderately ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: No shutdown available for this code. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 40% per minute until the engine is running at 60% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,0000079 1907DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-126
PN=286
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 Engine Coolant Temperature High Moderately Severe - Continued
RG40854,00000BD 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 Engine Coolant Temperature High Moderately Severe Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH MODERATELY SEVERE supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,127
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH MODERATELY SEVERE supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 110 FMI 16 occurs, using a temperature gauge, verify that engine coolant temperature is above 113C (235F).
ECT above 113C (235F): Engine overheating problem. See 4.5L/6.8L C1 - ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE ABOVE NORMAL in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104). ECT significantly less than 113C (235F): Verify that ECT sensor input and ground circuits are OK. If ECT sensor circuits are OK, replace ECT sensor and retest
NOTE: On OEM applications, the moderately high ECT specification is 113C(235F). For the moderately high ECT specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-127
PN=287
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High
Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor t Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector Sensor Ground
B A B A
Input C1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1924JAN02 RG11981
04 160 ,128
ECU HARNESS CONNECTOR Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor The loss of coolant temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature to detect whether there is a loss of coolant. The sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower loss of coolant temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further loss of coolant temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 will set if:
The ECU senses a coolant temperature above 124C (255F). If DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 sets, the following will occur: The engine derates 20% per minute until the engine is running at 60% of full power. If the temperature goes below 124C (255F), the engine will regain power at 20% per minute.
RG40854,000006F 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-128
PN=288
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High Continued
RG40854,00000BE 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 Loss of Coolant Temperature Extremely High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE EXTREMELY HIGH supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the loss of coolant temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,129
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE EXTREMELY HIGH supporting information
Under the conditions where DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 occurs, using a temperature gauge, verify that loss of coolant temperature is above 124C (255F).
Significantly less than 124C (255F): Verify that loss of coolant temperature sensor input and ground circuits are OK. If loss of coolant temperature sensor circuits are OK, replace loss of coolant temperature sensor and retest Temperature above 124C (255F): Engine overheating problem. See 4.5L/6.8L C1 - ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE ABOVE NORMAL in Section 04, Group 150 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-129
PN=289
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High
Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor t Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector Sensor Ground
B A B A
Input C1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1924JAN02 RG11981
04 160 ,130
ECU HARNESS CONNECTOR Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor The loss of coolant temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature to detect whether there is a loss of coolant. The sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower loss of coolant temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further loss of coolant temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 will set if:
The loss of coolant temperature input voltage exceeds 4.975 volts. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is lower than what is physically possible for engine coolant. If DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: ECUs high loss of coolant temperature engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,00000C0 1919DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-130
PN=290
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Continued
RG40854,00000C1 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the loss of coolant temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,131
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 111 FMI 3 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 111 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-131
PN=291
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect loss of coolant temperature sensor connector 3. Install a jumper wire between both terminals in the loss of coolant temperature sensor harness connector 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 111 FMI 3 reoccurs: GO TO 4 SPN 111 FMI 4 occurs: Faulty loss of coolant temperature sensor connector OR Faulty loss of coolant temperature sensor
1/1
04 160 ,132
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 3 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire between both terminals 3. Install jumper wire between loss of coolant temperature sensor harness connector input terminal and a good chassis ground 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between loss of coolant temperature input (5V supply) terminal and a good chassis ground.
Between 4.0 V and 6.0 V: Open in loss of coolant temperature input sensor circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU Below 4.0 V: Open in loss of coolant temperature sensor ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-132
PN=292
04 160 ,133
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-133
PN=293
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low
Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor t Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector Sensor Ground
B A B A
Input C1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1924JAN02 RG11981
04 160 ,134
ECU HARNESS CONNECTOR Loss of Coolant Temperature Sensor The loss of coolant temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) mounted in the rear of the cylinder head. It is used to measure the coolant temperature to detect whether there is a loss of coolant. The sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher coolant temperatures result in lower loss of coolant temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. For further loss of coolant temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 earlier in this manual. DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 will set if:
The loss of coolant temperature input voltage drops below 0.05 volts. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is higher than what is physically possible for engine coolant. If DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: ECUs high loss of coolant temperature engine protection feature disabled.
RG40854,0000069 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-134
PN=294
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Continued
RG40854,00000C2 1919DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 Loss of Coolant Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the loss of coolant temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,135
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine OFF 7. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 111 FMI 4 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 111 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-135
PN=295
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, DTC SPN 111 FMI 4 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect loss of coolant temperature sensor connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 111 FMI 4 reoccurs: Short to ground in loss of coolant temperature sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU SPN 111 FMI 3 occurs: Faulty loss of coolant temperature sensor
1/1
04 160 ,136
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-136
PN=296
04 160 ,137
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-137
PN=297
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU Power Down Error
Battery Ignition Switch VSW 30 A VBAT K1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
A2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11982
04 160 ,138
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 will set if: ECU detects voltage is on the switched voltage input wire to the ECU.
If DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 sets, the following will occur: Vehicle battery may be drained because ECU will not power down.
RG40854,0000066 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-138
PN=298
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU Power Down Error - Continued
RG40854,0000109 1915JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU Power Down Error Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU POWER DOWN ERROR supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, ignition power circuit, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,139
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU POWER DOWN ERROR supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Cycle ignition OFF for 10 seconds, then back ON 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 158 FMI 17 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 158 FMI 17 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-139
PN=299
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 158 FMI 17 ECU POWER DOWN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the ECU connector 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between terminal A2 the ECU wiring harness connector and a good chassis ground.
Measurement above 3.0 V: Faulty ignition switch circuit OR ECU key-on power supply shorted to voltage OR Faulty ignition switch Measurement below 3.0 V: Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
04 160 ,140
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-140
PN=300
04 160 ,141
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-141
PN=301
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage High
Fuel Temp Sensor t Fuel Temp Connector B A B A
Sensor Ground Fuel Temp Input
C3
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1908JAN02 RG11988
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
04 160 ,142
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Fuel Temperature Sensor The fuel temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) located on the injection pump fuel outlet housing. The fuel temperature sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher fuel temperatures result in lower fuel temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. The ECU uses the fuel temperature sensor input to adjust the fuel delivery for the variations in fuel density caused by varying fuel temperatures. For more fuel temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual.
DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 will set if: The fuel temperature input voltage goes above the sensors high voltage specification. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is lower than what is physically possible for fuel temperature. For OEM engine applications, the high fuel temperature input voltage specification is 4.9 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the high fuel temperature input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use a "limp-home" fuel temperature value of -20C (-4F) during cranking, and 40C (104F) during running. Engine power will be slightly derated.
RG40854,0000062 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-142
PN=302
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage High - Continued
RG40854,00000F3 1907JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the fuel temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,143
1/1
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine running 5. Read the Fuel Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
4.9 V or greater: GO TO 3 Below 4.9 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
NOTE: On OEM applications, the high fuel temperature input voltage specification is 4.9 volts and above. For fuel temperature input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-143
PN=303
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect fuel temperature sensor connector 3. Install a jumper wire between both terminals in the fuel temperature sensor harness connector 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Fuel Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: GO TO 4 At or below 0.1 V: Faulty fuel temperature sensor connector OR Faulty fuel temperature sensor
NOTE: On OEM applications, the low fuel temperature input voltage specification is 0.1 volts and below. For fuel temperature input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,144
1/1
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 3 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove jumper wire between both terminals 3. Install jumper wire between fuel temperature sensor harness connector input terminal and a good chassis ground 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Fuel Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Above 0.1 V: Open in fuel temperature input sensor circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU 0.1 V or below: Open in fuel temperature sensor ground circuit OR Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
NOTE: On OEM applications, the low fuel temperature input voltage specification is 0.1 volts and below. For fuel temperature input voltage specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-144
PN=304
04 160 ,145
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-145
PN=305
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Low
Fuel Temp Sensor t Fuel Temp Connector B A B A
Sensor Ground Fuel Temp Input
C3
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1908JAN02 RG11988
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
04 160 ,146
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Fuel Temperature Sensor The fuel temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) located on the injection pump fuel outlet housing. The fuel temperature sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher fuel temperatures result in lower fuel temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. The ECU uses the fuel temperature sensor input to adjust the fuel delivery for the variations in fuel density caused by varying fuel temperatures. For more fuel temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual.
DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 will set if: The fuel temperature input voltage goes above the sensors low voltage specification. This voltage corresponds to a temperature that is higher than what is physically possible for fuel temperature. For OEM engine applications, the low fuel temperature input voltage specification is 0.1 volts. For other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual for the low fuel temperature input voltage specification. If DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use a "limp-home" fuel temperature value of -20C (-4F) during cranking, and 40C (104F) during running. Engine power will be slightly derated.
RG40854,0000064 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-146
PN=306
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Low - Continued
RG40854,00000F2 1907JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 Fuel Temperature Input Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the fuel temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,147
1/1
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 4 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Ignition ON, engine OFF 5. Read the Fuel Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR
0.1 V or below: GO TO 3 Above 0.1 V: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the low fuel temperature input voltage specification is 0.1V. For the low voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-147
PN=307
NOTE: For wiring, theory of operation, and sensor location information, seeDTC SPN 174 FMI 4 FUEL TEMPERATURE INPUT VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect fuel temperature sensor connector 3. Ignition ON 4. Read the Fuel Temperature Input Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
Below 4.9 V: Short to ground in fuel temperature sensor input circuit OR Faulty ECU 4.9 V or greater: Faulty fuel temperature sensor
NOTE: For OEM engine applications, the high fuel temperature input voltage specification is 4.9V. For the high voltage specification on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
04 160 ,148
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-148
PN=308
04 160 ,149
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-149
PN=309
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 Fuel Temperature Moderately High
Fuel Temp Sensor t Fuel Temp Connector B A B A
Sensor Ground Fuel Temp Input
C3
D3
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1908JAN02 RG11988
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
04 160 ,150
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Fuel Temperature Sensor The fuel temperature sensor is a thermistor (temperature sensitive resistor) located on the injection pump fuel outlet housing. The fuel temperature sensors variable resistance causes the input voltage to the ECU to vary. Higher fuel temperatures result in lower fuel temperature input voltages to the ECU; lower temperatures result in higher voltages. The ECU uses the fuel temperature sensor input to adjust the fuel delivery for the variations in fuel density caused by varying fuel temperatures. For more fuel temperature sensor information, see MEASURING TEMPERATURE in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 will set if:
The ECU senses fuel temperature on OEM applications above 120C (248F). For fuel temperature specifications on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual. If DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 sets, the following will occur: Engine protection is enabled. See ENGINE PROTECTION in Section 03, Group 140 of this manual. With Shutdown Feature: No shutdown available for this code. With Derate Feature: On OEM applications, the engine derates 2% per minute until the engine is running at 80% of full power. For non-OEM applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG40854,0000061 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-150
PN=310
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 Fuel Temperature Moderately High - Continued
RG40854,00000F5 1908JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 Fuel Temperature Moderately High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
Before using this diagnostic procedure: 1. Ensure that the fuel level in the fuel tank is not extremely low 2. Ensure that fuel cooler is clean
04 160 ,151
2 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 FUEL TEMPERATURE MODERATELY HIGH supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the fuel temperature sensor connector, and any connectors in between them. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 FUEL TEMPERATURE MODERATELY HIGH supporting information
Determine fuel supply pressure. See CHECK FUEL SUPPLY PRESSURE in Section 04, Group 150 of this manual.
Fuel pressure within specification: GO TO 4 Fuel pressure below specification: Determine cause of low fuel supply pressure. See F1 - FUEL SUPPLY SYSTEM CHECK DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE in Section 04, Group 150 of this manual. Repair and retest.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-151
PN=311
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 FUEL TEMPERATURE MODERATELY supporting information.
Check return fuel lines for restriction between fuel tank and: Overflow valve on injection pump Fuel leak off line at injection nozzles
Fuel return lines NOT restricted: Faulty fuel cooler OR Faulty injection pump Restriction found in either fuel return line: Determine the cause of restriction Repair and retest
1/1
04 160 ,152
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-152
PN=312
04 160 ,153
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-153
PN=313
B2
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1923JAN02 RG11984
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Crank Position Sensor The crank position sensor is located on the front of the crankshaft, behind the pressed-on crank gear. It is an inductive type pickup sensor that detects teeth on the crank timing wheel. The ECU uses the crank position input to determine engine speed and precise piston position in relation to the firing order. The crank timing wheel is composed of 46 evenly spaced teeth and 2 missing teeth. The missing teeth help the ECU to determine Top-Dead-Center (TDC). DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 will set if: The ECU detects that engine speed exceeds 3400 rpm.
If DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 sets, the following will occur: The ECU shuts fuel off until engine speed is below 2800 rpm. If DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 sets: With DTC SPN 190 FMI 0, there may or not be a problem with the electronic control system. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, monitor DTCs on the active code display parameter. To find DTC list, see LISTING OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) ON ECU earlier in this Group. If there are other codes, go to the appropriate diagnostic procedure. If there are no other stored or active DTCs, clear DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 and monitor codes to see if DTC SPN 190 FMI 0 reoccurs.
RG40854,0000148 1911FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-154
PN=314
B2
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1923JAN02 RG11984
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Crank Position Sensor The crank position sensor is located on the front of the crankshaft, behind the pressed-on crank gear. It is an inductive type pickup sensor that detects teeth on the crank timing wheel. The ECU uses the crank position input to determine engine speed and precise piston position in relation to the firing order. The crank timing wheel is composed of 46 evenly spaced teeth and 2 missing teeth. The missing teeth help the ECU to determine Top-Dead-Center (TDC). DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 will set if: The ECU detects that engine speed is higher than 3000 rpm.
If DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 sets, the following will occur: The ECU shuts fuel off until engine speed is below 2800 rpm. If DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 sets: With DTC SPN 190 FMI 16, there may or not be a problem with the electronic control system. Using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, monitor DTCs on the active code display parameter. To find DTC list, see LISTING OF DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) ON ECU earlier in this Group. If there are other codes, go to the appropriate diagnostic procedure. If there are no other stored or active DTCs, clear DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 and monitor codes to see if DTC SPN 190 FMI 16 reoccurs.
04 160 ,155
RG40854,0000149 1911FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-155
PN=315
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High
A1 A2 A3
Analog Throttle (A) Sensor Analog Throttle (B) Sensor Oil Pressure Sensor E2
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,156
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Sensor Supply Voltage The ECU supplies voltage to a few different sensors depending on the application. The ECU monitors the drop in voltage that the sensor causes and compares that drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory to determine the value of the parameter the sensor was measuring. In addition,
the ECU monitors the exact voltage on the 5 volt supply circuit in order to ensure accurate readings. DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 will set if: The ECU detects a voltage that is higher than 5.5 volts on the ECU 5 volt sensor supply circuit. If DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use default values for the sensors that use sensor supply input voltage.
RG40854,000005C 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-156
RG11983
C O N N E C T O R
1924JAN02
PN=316
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High - Continued
RG40854,00000F6 1908JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,157
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine OFF 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 620 FMI 3 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 620 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-157
PN=317
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using multimeter, measure resistance between terminal E2 in the harness end of the ECU connector and all other terminals in the harness end of the ECU connector.
Greater than 20,000 ohms: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Less than 20,000 ohms: Short to voltage in sensor supply wire
1/1
04 160 ,158
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-158
PN=318
04 160 ,159
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-159
PN=319
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low
A1 A2 A3
Analog Throttle (A) Sensor Analog Throttle (B) Sensor Oil Pressure Sensor E2
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,160
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Sensor Supply Voltage The ECU supplies voltage to a few different sensors depending on the application. The ECU monitors the drop in voltage that the sensor causes and compares that drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory to determine the value of the
parameter the sensor was measuring. In addition, the ECU monitors the exact voltage on the 5 volt supply circuit in order to ensure accurate readings. DTC 620 FMI 4 will set if: The ECU detects a voltage that is lower than 4.44 volts on the ECU 5 volt sensor supply circuit. If DTC 620 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use default values for the sensors that use sensor supply input voltage.
RG40854,000005E 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-160
RG11983
C O N N E C T O R
1924JAN02
PN=320
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low - Continued
RG40854,00000F7 1908JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,161
1/1
2 Sensor Check
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition OFF 7. Disconnect all sensors that receive their 5V supply from terminal E2 of the ECU 8. Ignition ON, engine running 9. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 620 FMI 4 reoccurs: GO TO 4 SPN 620 FMI 4 does not reoccur: GO TO 3
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-161
PN=321
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition ON, engine OFF 2. While reconnecting each sensor one at a time, monitor DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 620 FMI 4 reoccurs: Faulty sensor Replace and retest SPN 620 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
04 160 ,162
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect the ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal D3 in the harness end of the ECU connector and: A good chassis ground Terminal J2 in the harness end of the ECU connector
Greater than 20,000 ohms: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Less than 20,000 ohms: Sensor 5 volt supply circuit shorted to ground
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-162
PN=322
04 160 ,163
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-163
PN=323
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU Unswitched Power Missing
Battery Ignition Switch VSW 30 A VBAT K1
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
A2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1914DEC01 RG11982
04 160 ,164
ECU HARNESS CONNECTOR DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 will set if: The ECU does not detect battery voltage. If DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur:
RG40854,000014B 1913FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-164
PN=324
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU Unswitched Power Missing - Continued
RG40854,000014C 1913FEB021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU Unswitched Power Missing Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 620 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,165
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU UNSWITCHED POWER MISSING supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make notes of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 627 FMI 4 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 627 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, seeINTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-165
PN=325
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU UNSWITCHED POWER MISSING supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure voltage between a good chassis ground and terminal K1
Voltage is substantially less than battery voltage: GO TO 4 Voltages are at or near battery voltage on both terminals: Faulty ECU connection OR Faulty ECU
1/1
04 160 ,166
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 627 FMI 4 ECU UNSWITCHED POWER MISSING supporting information.
Using a multimeter, measure battery voltage at the battery terminals.
Voltage within specification for battery: Faulty ECU power supply fuse OR Faulty ECU connection OR Open or short in ECU power circuit Voltage substantially less than battery voltage: Faulty battery or charging system
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-166
PN=326
04 160 ,167
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-167
PN=327
RG40854,000003C 1906DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 629 FMI 13 ECU Error Diagnostic Procedure
04 160 ,168
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 629 FMI 13 ECU ERROR supporting information.
1. Verify that controllers on vehicle are in correct location and connected to the correct wiring harness 2. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 3. Ignition ON, engine OFF 4. Start the ECU communication software 5. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 6. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 7. Ignition ON, engine running or cranking for 15 seconds 8. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 629 FMI 13 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 629 FMI 13 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-168
PN=328
04 160 ,169
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-169
PN=329
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 Crank Position Input Noise
Crank Position Sensor Crank Sensor Connector Crank Position Return
B A B A
B2
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1923JAN02 RG11984
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Crank Position Sensor The crank position sensor is located on the front of the crankshaft, behind the pressed-on crank gear. It is an inductive type pickup sensor that detects teeth on the crank timing wheel. The ECU uses the crank position input to determine engine speed and precise piston position in relation to the firing order.
The crank timing wheel is composed of 46 evenly spaced teeth and 2 missing teeth. The missing teeth help the ECU to determine Top-Dead-Center (TDC). DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 will set if: The ECU detects excessive noise (extra pulses) on the crank position input. If DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 sets, the following will occur: Engine probably will not run
RG40854,0000038 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-170
PN=330
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 Crank Position Input Noise - Continued
RG40854,00000F8 1908JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 Crank Position Input Noise Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 CRANK POSITION INPUT NOISE supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the crank position sensor connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,171
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 CRANK POSITION INPUT NOISE supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of all DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Warm engine 7. Ignition ON, engine running 8. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 637 FMI 2 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 637 FMI 2 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-171
PN=331
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 2 CRANK POSITION INPUT NOISE supporting information.
1. SPN 637 FMI 2 is most likely caused by radiated or conducted electrical "noise" from some part of the machine. This problem may be caused by loose electrical ground or power connections anywhere on the machine. Things to check: All harness connectors Alternator connections Chassis ground connections, battery ground connection Corrosion, dirt, or paint can cause intermittent and "noisy" connections Check the wiring for intermittent open and short circuits; particularly the crank sensor wiring Check wiring for proper pin location in the crank sensor and ECU connectors 2. Other possible causes of SPN 637 FMI 2: Electromagnetic interference (EMI) from an incorrectly installed 2-way radio Interference from some radar source Possible broken teeth on the crankshaft timing ring
04 160 ,172
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-172
PN=332
04 160 ,173
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-173
PN=333
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 Crank Position Input Pattern Error
Crank Position Sensor Crank Sensor Connector Crank Position Return
B A B A
B2
A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1
D2
F3 G3 H3 J3 K3 F2 G2 H2 J2 K2 F1 G1 H1 J1 K1
1923JAN02 RG11984
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Crank Position Sensor The crank position sensor is located on the front of the crankshaft, behind the pressed-on crank gear. It is an inductive type pickup sensor that detects teeth on the crank timing wheel. The ECU uses the crank position input to determine engine speed and precise piston position in relation to the firing order.
The crank timing wheel is composed of 46 evenly spaced teeth and 2 missing teeth. The missing teeth help the ECU to determine Top-Dead-Center (TDC). DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 will set if: The ECU detects an improper pattern on the crank position input. If DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 sets, the following will occur: Engine probably will not run.
RG40854,000003A 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-174
PN=334
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 Crank Position Input Pattern Error - Continued
RG40854,000010A 1915JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 Crank Position Input Pattern Error Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the crank position sensor connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,175
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON, engine running 7. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 637 FMI 10 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 637 FMI 10 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-175
PN=335
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect crank position sensor connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between both terminals of the crank position sensor.
Between 2500 and 3500 ohms: GO TO 4 Below 2500 ohms or above 3500 ohms: Faulty crank position sensor
1/1
04 160 ,176
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect crank position sensor connector 3. Disconnect ECU connector 4. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between: Terminal A of the crank position sensor harness connector and terminal B2 in the harness end of the ECU connector Terminal B of the crank position sensor harness connector and terminal D2 in the harness end of the ECU connector
Both measurements 5 ohms or less: GO TO 5 Either measurement greater than 5 ohms: Open in crank position sensor input wire OR Open in crank position sensor return wire OR Terminals A and B in the crank position sensor harness connector possibly inverted
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Crank position sensor connector and ECU connector still disconnected 3. Using a multimeter measure resistance between terminal B2 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the following: A good ground All other terminals in both ECU connectors
All measurements greater than 2000 ohms: GO TO 6 Any measurement less than 2000 ohms: Faulty crank position sensor input wiring harness
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-176
PN=336
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Crank position sensor connector and ECU connector still disconnected 3. Using a multimeter measure resistance between terminal D2 in the harness end of the ECU connector and the following: A good ground All other terminals in both ECU connectors
All measurements greater than 2000 ohms: GO TO 7 Any measurement less than 2000 ohms: Faulty crank position sensor return wiring harness
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Remove crank position sensor from injection pump 2. Remove crank position sensor 3. Inspect sensor for cracks, corrosion, or any foreign material on the end of the sensor 4. Inspect the crank timing wheel notches for burrs or chips
All components OK: GO TO 8 Fault found in a component: Repair or replace component as needed
04 160 ,177
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 637 FMI 10 CRANK POSITION INPUT PATTERN ERROR supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Remove timing cover 3. Check timing between camshaft, crankshaft, and injection pump gears. See INSTALL CAMSHAFT in Group 050 of 4.5 & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
All gears in time: Faulty crank position sensor connector OR Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU One or more gears out of time: Make necessary adjustments to ensure correct timing. See INSTALL CAMSHAFT in Section 02, Group 050 of 4.5 L & 6.8 L Diesel Engines Base Engine Manual (CTM 104).
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-177
PN=337
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
E F G
04 160 ,178
D C A J H B
D C E B A
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3
C O N N E C T O R
K1 K2 K3
Diagnostic Connector
C C CAN Terminator
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Controller Area Network (CAN) CAN is the network in which the individual controllers on a machine communicate with each other. The number of controllers communicating on CAN depends on the application. On some applications, the ECU is the only controller on CAN;
on other applications, there are many controllers on CAN. DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 will set if: The ECU detects a problem communicating on CAN. If DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 sets, the following will occur: Depending on the application, engine operation may or may not be affected.
RG40854,0000036 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-178
PN=338
RG11972
1914DEC01
B B A C
RG40854,000010F 1916JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN Error Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN ERROR supporting information
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the CAN connections, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,179
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN ERROR supporting information
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start ECU communication software 4. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. 5. Make note of all DTCs, then clear all DTCs 6. Ignition ON 7. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 reoccurs: GO TO 3 DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-179
PN=339
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN ERROR supporting information
If application has other machine controllers communicating on the CAN bus, check those controllers for CAN related DTCs
No CAN related DTCs found on other controllers: GO TO 4 Found CAN related DTCs on other controllers: Refer to machine manual to diagnose and repair the cause of DTC, then determine if DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 reoccurs
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN ERROR supporting information
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance betweenterminals F1 and G1 in the harness end of the ECU connector
Between 55 ohms and 65 ohms: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Less than 55 ohms or greater than 65 ohms: Open or short in CAN communication circuit
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-180
PN=340
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 898 FMI 9 Vehicle Speed or Torque Message Invalid
CAN (Controller Area Network) Vehicle Speed or Torque Message The CAN (Controller Area Network) transmits the vehicles desired engine speed or torque to the ECU from another controller. DTC SPN 898 FMI 9 will set if: The ECU does not receive the engine speed or torque message over CAN or it is not valid. If DTC SPN 898 FMI 9 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will default engine speed to low idle. If DTC SPN 898 FMI 9 sets: Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. With ignition ON and engine OFF, start the ECU communication software Read active DTCs and stored DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. If DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 also occurs, see DTC SPN 639 FMI 13 CAN ERROR DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group. If no other stored or active CAN or vehicle related DTCs are found, replace the ECU and retest.
04 160 ,181
RG40854,0000114 1922JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-181
PN=341
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 970 FMI 31 Auxiliary Engine Shutdown Switch Active
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3
D3 A1
C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,182
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
measured exceeds a certain value, the switch will close. When the switch is closed, the voltage is grounded, which will cause the ECU to shutdown the engine. DTC SPN 970 FMI 31 will set if: The ECU does not read an input voltage on the auxiliary engine shutdown input wire. If DTC SPN 970 FMI 31 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will shut the engine down immediately.
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
Auxiliary Engine Shutdown Switch On OEM applications, the engine shutdown switch is a normally open switch. When the property being
RG40854,000003E 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-182
RG12047
C O N N E C T O R
1924JAN02
PN=342
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 971 FMI 31 External Engine Derate Switch Active
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3
D3 C2
C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
measured exceeds a certain value, the switch will close. When the switch is closed, the voltage is grounded, which will cause the ECU to derate the engine. DTC SPN 971 FMI 31 will set if: The ECU does not read an input voltage. If DTC SPN 971 FMI 31 sets, the following will occur: On OEM applications, the ECU will derate the engine 2% per minute until the engine is running at 80% of full power. For derates on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
RG12046
C O N N E C T O R
1923JAN02
04 160 ,183
NOTE: Wiring schematic shows OEM engine applications only. For wiring on other applications, see APPLICATION SPECIFICATIONS in Section 06, Group 210 of this manual.
External Fuel Derate Switch On OEM applications, the external derate switch is a normally open switch. When property being
RG40854,000003F 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-183
PN=343
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,184
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an fuel control solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to the engine. For
more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 will set if: The ECU determines that the pump control valve takes too long to close. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 sets, the following will occur: Engine performance may be erratic.
RG40854,0000040 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-184
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=344
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long - Continued
RG40854,0000124 1929JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Long Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO LONG supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,185
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO LONG supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 0 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 0 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-185
PN=345
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 0 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO LONG supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 0 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 0 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
04 160 ,186
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-186
PN=346
04 160 ,187
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-187
PN=347
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,188
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an fuel control solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to the engine. For
more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 will set if: The ECU determines that the control valve closes too quickly. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 sets, the following will occur: Engine performance may be erratic.
RG40854,0000044 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-188
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=348
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short - Continued
RG40854,0000125 1929JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 Pump Control Valve Closure Too Short Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO SHORT supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,189
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO SHORT supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 1 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 1 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-189
PN=349
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO SHORT supporting information.
1. Ignition ON, engine OFF 2. Read the Battery Voltage parameter using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
At or near battery voltage: GO TO 4 Significantly above or below battery voltage: Faulty power supply
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 1 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE TOO SHORT supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 1 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 1 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-190
PN=350
04 160 ,191
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-191
PN=351
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 Pump Solenoid Current High
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,192
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to
the engine. For more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 will set if: The ECU determines that pump solenoid current is higher than normal. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: Engine performance may be erratic.
RG40854,0000046 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-192
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=352
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 Pump Solenoid Current High - Continued
RG40854,0000126 1929JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 Pump Solenoid Current High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 PUMP SOLENOID CURRENT HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,193
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 PUMP SOLENOID CURRENT HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 3 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-193
PN=353
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 PUMP SOLENOID CURRENT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between Terminal A3 and all other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 4 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Short to power in pump solenoid return wire
1/1
04 160 ,194
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 PUMP SOLENOID CURRENT HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between Terminal K2 and all other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 5 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Short to power in pump solenoid supply wire
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 3 PUMP SOLENOID CURRENT HIGH supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 3 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-194
PN=354
04 160 ,195
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-195
PN=355
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 Pump Solenoid Circuit Open
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,196
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to
the engine. For more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 will set if: The ECU determines that pump solenoid circuit is open. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 sets, the following will occur: Engine will not run.
RG40854,0000049 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-196
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=356
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 Pump Solenoid Circuit Open - Continued
RG40854,000004C 1906DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 Pump Solenoid Circuit Open Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT OPEN supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,197
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT OPEN supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 5 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 5 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-197
PN=357
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT OPEN supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF, engine OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal K2 and terminal A3 of the harness side of the ECU connector.
Measurement less than 5 ohms: GO TO 4 Measurment 5 ohms or greater: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU
1/1
04 160 ,198
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 5 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT OPEN supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between: Terminal K2 in the ECU connector and terminal A in the pump solenoid connector Terminal A3 in the ECU connector and terminal B in the pump solenoid connector
Both measurements less than 5 ohms: Faulty pump connector OR Faulty injection pump Either measurement greater than 5 ohms: Faulty pump connector OR Faulty ECU connector OR Open in pump solenoid supply wire OR Open in pump solenoid return wire
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-198
PN=358
04 160 ,199
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-199
PN=359
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,200
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to
the engine. For more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 will set if: The ECU determines that pump solenoid circuit is shorted. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 sets, the following will occur: ECU will shut engine down immediately.
RG40854,000004D 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-200
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=360
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted - Continued
RG40854,0000127 1929JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 Pump Solenoid Circuit Severely Shorted Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT SEVERELY SHORTED supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,201
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT SEVERELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISORearlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 6 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 6 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-201
PN=361
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT SEVERELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal K2 of the harness side of the ECU connector and: A good ground All other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 4 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Pump solenoid supply wire shorted
1/1
04 160 ,202
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT SEVERELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal A3 of the harness side of the ECU connector and: A good ground All other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 5 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Pump solenoid return wire shorted
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 6 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT SEVERELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 6 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 6 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-202
PN=362
04 160 ,203
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-203
PN=363
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,204
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to
the engine. For more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 will set if: The ECU determines that it can not detect the closure of the pump control valve. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 sets, the following will occur: Engine performance may be erratic.
RG40854,000004F 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-204
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=364
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected Continued
RG40854,0000050 1906DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 Pump Control Valve Closure Not Detected Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE NOT DETECTED supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,205
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE NOT DETECTED supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 7 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 7 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-205
PN=365
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 7 PUMP CONTROL VALVE CLOSURE NOT DETECTED supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 7 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 7 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
04 160 ,206
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-206
PN=366
04 160 ,207
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-207
PN=367
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted
Pump Solenoid
A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
04 160 ,208
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to the engine. For more operation information, see
FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual. DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 will set if: Pump solenoid circuit is moderately shorted to power. If DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 sets, the following will occur: ECU will derate engine to 50% of full power immediately.
RG40854,0000051 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-208
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
PN=368
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted Continued
RG40854,0000050 1906DEC011/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 Pump Solenoid Circuit Moderately Shorted Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT MODERATELY SHORTED supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the pump connector, and any other connector. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,209
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT MODERATELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine cranking or running 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 10 reoccurs: GO TO 3 SPN 1076 FMI 10 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-209
PN=369
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT MODERATELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal K2 of the harness side of the ECU connector and: A good ground All other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 4 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Pump solenoid supply wire shorted
1/1
04 160 ,210
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT MODERATELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect pump solenoid connector and ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal A3 of the harness side of the ECU connector and: A good ground All other terminals in the ECU connector
Measurement greater than 20,000 ohms: GO TO 5 Measurement less than 20,000 ohms: Pump solenoid return wire shorted
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1076 FMI 10 PUMP SOLENOID CIRCUIT MODERATELY SHORTED supporting information.
1. Remove and install new injection pump. See REMOVE INJECTION PUMP and INSTALL INJECTION PUMP in Section 02, Group 090 of this manual. 2. Ignition ON, engine running. 3. Read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1076 FMI 10 reoccurs: Faulty ECU SPN 1076 FMI 10 does not reoccur: Problem repaired
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-210
PN=370
04 160 ,211
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-211
PN=371
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High
Analog Throttle (A) Sensor Connector Analog Throttle (A) Sensor A B C A B C Sensor Return Sensor 5V D3 E2
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3 A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
04 160 ,212
Sensor Supply Voltage The ECU supplies voltage to a few different sensors depending on the application. The ECU monitors the drop in voltage that the sensor causes and compares that drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory to determine the value of the parameter the sensor was measuring. In addition, the ECU monitors the exact voltage on the 5 volt supply circuit in order to ensure accurate readings.
DTC 1079 FMI 3 will set if: The ECU detects a voltage that is higher than 5.5 volts on the ECU 5 volt sensor supply circuit. If DTC 1079 FMI 3 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use default values for the sensors that use sensor supply input voltage.
RG40854,0000052 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-212
PN=372
RG12044
C O N N E C T O R
1923JAN02
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High - Continued
RG40854,000010E 1916JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 Sensor Supply Voltage High Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog throttle (A) connector, and any connectors in between. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,213
1/1
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make notes of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition ON, engine OFF 6. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1079 FMI 3 reoccur: GO TO 3 SPN 1079 FMI 3 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-213
PN=373
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, DTC SPN 1079 FMI 3 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE HIGH supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance between terminal E2 the harness end of the ECU connector and all other terminals in the harness end of the ECU connector
Greater than 20,000 ohms: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Less than 20,000 ohms: Short to voltage in sensor supply wire
1/1
04 160 ,214
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-214
PN=374
04 160 ,215
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-215
PN=375
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low
Analog Throttle (A) Sensor Connector Analog Throttle (A) Sensor A B C A B C Sensor Return Sensor 5V D3 E2
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3 A1 A2 A3
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3 E1 E2 E3
E C U H A R N E S S
04 160 ,216
Sensor Supply Voltage The ECU supplies voltage to a few different sensors depending on the application. The ECU monitors the drop in voltage that the sensor causes and compares that drop to preprogrammed values in the ECUs memory to determine the value of the parameter the sensor was measuring. In addition, the ECU monitors the exact voltage on the 5 volt supply circuit in order to ensure accurate readings.
DTC 1079 FMI 4 will set if: The ECU detects a voltage that is lower than 4.44 volts on the ECU 5 volt sensor supply circuit. If DTC 1079 FMI 4 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will use default values for the sensors that use sensor supply input voltage.
RG40854,0000054 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-216
PN=376
RG12044
C O N N E C T O R
1923JAN02
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low - Continued
RG40854,000010D 1916JAN021/1
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 Sensor Supply Voltage Low Diagnostic Procedure
1/1
1 Connection Check
IMPORTANT: Do not force probes into connector terminals or damage will result. Use JT07328 Connector Adapter Test Kit to make measurements in connectors. This will ensure that terminal damage does not occur.
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
Perform a preliminary inspection of the ECU connector, the analog throttle (A) connector, and any connectors in between. Look for dirty, damaged, or poorly positioned terminals.
04 160 ,217
1/1
2 Sensor Check
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Connect the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR. For instructions on connecting to the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR, see CONNECTING TO DIAGNOSTIC SCAN TOOL (DST) OR SERVICE ADVISOR earlier in this Group. 2. Ignition ON, engine OFF 3. Start the ECU communication software 4. Make note of any DTCs, then clear all DTCs 5. Ignition OFF 6. Disconnect all of the sensors that receive their 5 V supply from terminal E2 in the ECU connector. 7. Ignition ON, engine running 8. Read DTCs using DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1079 FMI 4 reoccurs: GO TO 4 SPN 1079 FMI 4 does not reoccur: GO TO 3
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-217
PN=377
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition ON 2. While reconnecting each of the sensors one at a time, read DTCs using the DST or SERVICE ADVISOR.
SPN 1079 FMI 4 reoccurs: Sensor that reset the DTC is faulty Replace and retest SPN 1079 FMI 4 does not reoccur: Problem is intermittent. If no other codes are present, see INTERMITTENT FAULT DIAGNOSTICS, earlier in this Group.
1/1
04 160 ,218
NOTE: For wiring and theory of operation information, see DTC SPN 1079 FMI 4 SENSOR SUPPLY VOLTAGE LOW supporting information.
1. Ignition OFF 2. Disconnect ECU connector 3. Using a multimeter, measure resistance individually between terminal E2 in the harness end of the ECU connector and: A good chassis ground Terminal J2 in the harness end of the ECU connector Terminal D3 in the harness end of the ECU connector
Greater than 20,000 ohms: Faulty ECU connector OR Faulty ECU Less than 20,000 ohms: Sensor 5 volt supply circuit shorted to a ground
1/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-218
PN=378
04 160 ,219
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-219
PN=379
Level 12 ECU - DTC SPN 1109 FMI 31 Engine Protection Shutdown Warning
Engine Shutdown Warning: This code informs the operator that the ECU will shut the engine down because it has detected a condition such as low oil pressure, high engine coolant temperature, high loss of coolant temperature, low coolant level, high fuel temperature, or a faulty injection pump. If the ECU is programmed with engine protection with shutdown, the ECU has shut the engine down within 30 seconds. Prior to shutdown, the engine will be derated.
04 160 ,220
If the ECU has engine protection with shutdown, it will derate (according to relating DTC) the engine for 30 seconds and will shut the engine down. If DTC 1109 FMI 31 sets: If DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 is active, see DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE EXTREMELY LOW DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group of the manual. If DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 is active, see DTC SPN 110 FMI 0 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE HIGH MOST SEVERE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group of the manual. If DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 is active, see DTC SPN 111 FMI 0 LOSS OF COOLANT TEMPERATURE EXTREMELY HIGH DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group of the manual. If DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 is active, see DTC SPN 174 FMI 16 FUEL TEMPERATURE MODERATELY HIGH DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE earlier in this Group of the manual.
DTC SPN 1109 FMI 31 will set if: The The The The ECU ECU ECU ECU detects detects detects detects low oil pressure. a high engine coolant temperature. a high loss of coolant temperature. a high fuel temperature.
RG40854,0000056 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-220
PN=380
04 160 ,221
If DTC SPN 1110 FMI 31 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will have shut the engine down.
RG40854,0000057 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-221
PN=381
04 160 ,222
If DTC SPN 1569 FMI 31 sets, the following will occur: The ECU will limit the amount of fuel available to the engine in an attempt to protect the engine. If DTC SPN 1569 FMI 31 sets: If DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 or DTC SPN 100 FMI 18 is active, see one of the following procedures earlier in this Group of the manual: DTC SPN 100 FMI 1 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE EXTREMELY LOW DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
RG40854,0000058 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-222
PN=382
B1 B2 B3 C1 C2 C3
D1 D2 D3
E C U H A R N E S S
A3 K2
E1 E2 E3
F1 F2 F3 G1 G2 G3 H1 H2 H3 J1 J2 J3 K1 K2 K3
Stanadyne DE10 Injection Pump The Stanadyne DE10 injection pump has an internal solenoid that is controlled by the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The ECU switches current on and off in order to charge the solenoid. When the current to the solenoid is increased, it moves a pump control valve into a position that allows for injection pressure to be developed. When the current to the solenoid is decreased, the pump control valve will return to a position that ends injection pressure. By controlling current to the solenoid, the ECU has the ability to manage the quantity and timing of fuel delivery to the engine. For more operation information, see FUEL INJECTION PUMP OPERATION in Section 03, Group 130 of this manual.
DTC SPN 2000 FMI 6 will set if: ECU has detected a short in the ECU that causes an extremely high current at the injection pump. If DTC SPN 2000 FMI 6 sets, the following will occur: Engine shuts down immediately If DTC SPN 2000 FMI 6 sets: Replace the ECU and retest.
RG11985
1920DEC01
C O N N E C T O R
04 160 ,223
RG40854,000005A 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-223
PN=383
The ECU will allow the engine to start, but will only allow low idle engine speed. If DTC SPN 2000 FMI 13 sets: If one of the controllers on the machine has just been replaced, make sure the correct controller was installed. If all controllers on the machine are the correct part numbers, check to see if any of the controllers have active or stored CAN related DTCs. If they do, go to the appropriate diagnostic procedure.
RG40854,000005B 1906DEC011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
04-160-224
PN=384
Section 05
Group 170Electronic Fuel/Control System Repair Tools and Other Materials Fuel System Repair and Adjustment Essential Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .05-170-1 Fuel System Repair and Adjustment Service Equipment and Tools . . . . . . . . . . .05-170-3 Fuel System Repair and Adjustment Other Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .05-170-4 Control System Repair and Adjustment Essential Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .05-170-5 Control System Repair and Adjustment Other Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .05-170-9
05
Group 180Diagnostic Service Tools Electronic Fuel System Diagnostic Tools. . . . .05-180-1
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-1
PN=1
Contents
05
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-2
PN=2
Group 170
OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV011/10
Injection Pump Drive Gear Puller . . . . . . . . . . JDG1560 Remove drive gear from tapered shaft of injection pump.
JDG1560
05 170 1
DE10 Injection Pump Timing Pin . . . . . . . . . . JDG1559 Used for static lock pin timing during installation of injection pump.
JDG1559
OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV013/10
Timing Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG1571 Used to lock flywheel at No. 1 TDC for injection pump timing. This timing pin MUST be used on engine applications using the tapered-nose crankshaft due to the higher torque specification for damper retaining cap screw.
JDG1571
OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV014/10
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-1
PN=387
RG12031
UN20DEC01
Injection Nozzle Puller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG1515-1 Use with slide hammer to remove injection nozzles.
JDG1515-1
Nozzle Bore Cleaning Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDE39 Clean injection nozzle bore in cylinder head.
JDE39
05 170 2
Spring Chamber Cap Wrench . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG1521 Used to remove the spring chamber cap on RSN nozzles.
JDG1521
Pressure Adjusting Screw Tool . . . . . . . . . . . JDG1522 Used to adjust opening pressure on RSN nozzles.
JDG1522
Continued on next page OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV018/10
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-2
PN=388
Pressure Adjusting Screw Lock Nut Wrench . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG1515-2 Used to loosen or tighten lock nut of pressure adjusting screws.
OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV019/10
Nozzle Carbon Stop Seal Installer . . . . . JD258 (JD-258) Used to install carbon stop seal in injection nozzle groove.
UN22JUL92 RG6254
JD258 (JD-258)
05 170 3
OUO1080,000020F 1927NOV0110/10
OUO1080,0000210 1927NOV011/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-3
PN=389
JT25510
05 170 4
OUO1080,0000210 1927NOV013/3
Apply to fuel supply pump mounting screws and fuel line fittings.
OUO1080,0000211 1927NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-4
PN=390
CD30307
UN07MAR95
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR021/17
Terminal Extraction Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .JDG364 Used to extract WEATHER PACK terminals from electrical connectors.
05 170 5
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR022/17
WEATHER PACK Crimping Tool . . . . . . . . . . JDG783 Used to crimp WEATHER PACK male and female terminals on 14-20 gauge wires. This tool crimps both the wire and the seal retainer at the same time.
UN07MAR02
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR023/17
METRI-PACK Crimping Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG865 Used to crimp METRI-PACK male and female terminals on 14-20 gauge wires.
UN07MAR02
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR024/17
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-5
RW25542A
RW25542A
PN=391
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR025/17
Technicians Electrical Repair Kit . . . . . . . . . . . JDG155 This kit is assembled with the most commonly used terminal extraction tools used to repair wiring harnesses on John Deere applications. This kit includes the following: JDG107 - Holding Plate, JDG139 - Sure-Seal terminal insertion tool, JDG140 - CPC and Metrimate terminal extraction tool, JDG141 - CPC Blade Type terminal extraction tool, JDG142 - Mate-N-Lock terminal extraction tool, JDG143 - Mate-N-Lock terminal extraction tool, JDG144 - Universal Crimping Pliers, JDG145 Electricians Pliers, JDG146 - Carrying Case, and JDG785 - Deutsch 6-8 gauge terminal extraction/insertion tool.
RG11679
UN05FEB01
05 170 6
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR026/17
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR027/17
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-6
RG11686
UN13FEB01
PN=392
RW25558
UN29AUG96
RW25558
UN29AUG96
METRI-PACK Extractor (Wide) . . . . . . . . . . . JDG776 Used to remove terminals from 56-Series, 280-Series, and 630-Series METRI-PACK connectors.
05 170 7
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR029/17
METRI-PACK Extractor (Narrow) . . . . . . . . . . JDG777 Used to remove terminals from 150-Series METRI-PACK, SUMITOMO, and YAZAKI connectors.
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0210/17
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-7
PN=393
JDG359
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0211/17
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0212/17
05 170 8
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0213/17
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0214/17
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0215/17
Terminal Extraction Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FKM10457 Used to extract terminals from ECU connector.
FKM10457
Continued on next page RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0216/17
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-8
PN=394
RW25540
Crimping Pliers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .JDG144 Used to crimp wire terminal ends for ECU connector.
JDG144
RG40854,0000003 1912MAR0217/17
JDT405 (U.S.) TY9375 (U.S.) TY9480 (Canadian) 592 (LOCTITE) AT66865 (U.S.)
Lubricant
OUO1080,0000215 1927NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-9
PN=395
05 170 10
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-170-10
PN=396
Group 180
RG40854,0000002 1909APR021/9
Fuel System Cap Plug Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JDG998 Used to protect the fuel system from dirt and debris when disconnecting fuel system components during fuel transfer pump pressure check.
UN20MAY98
05 180 1
JDG998
Universal Pressure Test Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JT05412 Used for testing engine oil pressure, intake manifold pressure (turbo boost), and fuel supply pump pressure.
JT05412
RG40854,0000002 1909APR023/9
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-180-1
RG8518
PN=397
JDIS122
RG40854,0000002 1909APR024/9
05 180 2
NOTE: Available from John Deere Distribution Service Center (DSC). United States and Canadian Agricultural dealers DO NOT ORDER without first contacting your Branch or TAM.
RG40854,0000002 1909APR025/9
ECU Communication Hardware Kit . . . . . . . . . . JDIS121 Used with JDIS122 - ECU Communication Software Kit. Together, the kits enable a Windows (95 or 98) or NT compatible computer to read information from the Engine Control Unit (ECU). The computer must be at least a 486/66 with 8 MB of RAM and an IEEE 1284 compliant parallel port.
UN09JUL01
RG8554
RG40854,0000002 1909APR026/9
NOTE: Available from John Deere Distribution Service Center (DSC). United States and Canadian Agricultural dealers DO NOT ORDER without first contacting your Branch or TAM.
Continued on next page RG40854,0000002 1909APR027/9
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-180-2
PN=398
RG11747
RG40854,0000002 1909APR028/9
Connector Adapter Test Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . JT07328 Used with JT05791 Digital Multimeter to make voltage and resistance measurements in control system wiring harness connectors. Can also be used to test terminals for proper fit.
05 180 3
UN26NOV97
JT07328
RG40854,0000002 1909APR029/9
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-180-3
RG8803
PN=399
RG11126
05 180 4
CTM331 (09APR02)
05-180-4
PN=400
Section 06
Specifications
Contents
Page Page
Group 200Repair Specifications Unified Inch Bolt and Cap Screw Torque Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-1 Metric Bolt and Cap Screw Torque Values . . .06-200-2 General OEM Engine Specifications . . . . . . . .06-200-3 Electronic Fuel System Repair and Adjustment Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-4 Electronic Engine Control Repair and Adjustment Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-5 Group 210Diagnostic Specifications Group 150/160 Electronic Fuel System Diagnostic Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-1 Application Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Backhoes - Sensor Specifications . . . . . . . . . .06-210-4 Backhoes - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . . . .06-210-4 Backhoes - Governor Mode Selection . . . . . . .06-210-5 Backhoes - ECU Terminal Identification . . . . .06-210-5 Crawlers - Sensor Specifications. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-6 Crawlers - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . . . . .06-210-7 Crawlers - Governor Mode Selection. . . . . . . .06-210-7 Crawlers - ECU Terminal Identification . . . . . .06-210-8 Excavators - Sensor Specifications . . . . . . . .06-210-10 Excavators - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . .06-210-11 Excavators - Governor Mode Selection . . . . .06-210-11 Excavators - ECU Terminal Identification . . .06-210-12 Forwarders - Sensor Specifications . . . . . . . .06-210-14 Forwarders - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . .06-210-16 Forwarders - Governor Mode Selection. . . . .06-210-16 Forwarders - ECU Terminal Identification . . .06-210-17 Harvesters - Sensor Specifications . . . . . . . .06-210-18 Harvesters - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . .06-210-19 Harvesters - Governor Mode Selection . . . . .06-210-19 Harvesters - ECU Terminal Identification. . . .06-210-20 OEM Engines - Sensor Specifications . . . . . .06-210-22 OEM Engines - Torque Curve Selection . . . .06-210-24 OEM Engines - Governor Mode Selection. . .06-210-24 OEM Engines - ECU Terminal Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-25 OEM Engines - Electronic Control System Wiring Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-26 OEM Engines - 4.5L & 6.8L Instrument Panel/Engine Start Components Electrical Wiring Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-28 Skidders - Sensor Specifications . . . . . . . . . .06-210-30 Skidders - Torque Curve Selection . . . . . . . .06-210-31 CTM331 (09APR02)
Skidders - Governor Mode Selection . . . . . . .06-210-31 Skidders - ECU Terminal Identification . . . . .06-210-32 Telehandlers - Sensor Specifications . . . . . .06-210-34 Telehandlers - Torque Curve Selection . . . . .06-210-35 Telehandlers - Governor Mode Selection . . .06-210-35 Telehandlers - ECU Terminal Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-36
06
06-1
PN=1
Contents
06
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-2
PN=2
Group 200
Repair Specifications
Unified Inch Bolt and Cap Screw Torque Values
06 200 1
DX,TORQ1 1920JUL941/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-1
PN=403
TS1656
1902APR97
Repair Specifications
06 200 2
DX,TORQ2 1920JUL941/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-2
PN=404
TS1657
1902APR97
Repair Specifications
06 200 3
DPSG,OUO1004,102 1919NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-3
PN=405
Repair Specifications
Final Fuel Filter Bracket-to-Cylinder Head Final Fuel Filter Mounting Base-to-Bracket Primary Fuel Filter Bracket-to-Cylinder Head and Alternator Primary Fuel Filter/Water Bowl Mounting Base-to-Bracket Fuel Supply Pump
Torque
73 Nm (54 lb-ft)
Torque
73 Nm (54 lb-ft)
Torque
73 Nm (54 lb-ft)
Torque
50 Nm (36 lb-ft)
Pressure
2841 kPa (0.280.41 bar) (46 psi) 30 Nm (22 lb-ft) 25 Nm (19 lb-ft) 195 Nm (145 lb-ft) 27 Nm (20 lb-ft) 9.5 Nm (7.5 lb-ft)
Fuel Supply Pump Cap Screws Injection Pump Mounting Stud Nuts Injection Pump Gear Mounting Nut
06 200 4
Injection Pump Fuel Delivery (Pressure) Lines Injection Pump Timing Pin Plug Fuel Injection Nozzle Nozzle
Torque
Fuel Injection Nozzle Rate Shaping Nozzle Opening Pressure for Setting (New or Reconditioned) Opening Pressure for Checking (New or Reconditioned) Opening Pressure for Setting (Used) Opening Pressure for Checking (Used) 24 40024 900 kPa (244249 bar) (35403620 psi) 24 100 kPa (241 bar) (3500 psi) Min 23 00023 600 kPa (230236 bar) (33403420 psi) 21 800 kPa (218 bar) (3170 psi) Min
OUO1080,0000212 1927NOV011/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-4
PN=406
Repair Specifications
Item
Measurement
Specification
Fuel Injection Nozzle Pressure Adjusting Screw Lock Nut Lift Adjusting Screw Lock Nut Torque 10 Nm (7 lb-ft)
Torque
5 Nm (3.5 lb-ft)
Fuel Injection Nozzle Hold-Down Clamp Cap Screws Fuel Leak-Off Line Hex Nut
Torque
40 Nm (30 lb-ft)
Torque
Fuel Injection Pump Return Line Fuel Injection Nozzle Delivery Lines
Torque Torque
OUO1080,0000212 1927NOV012/2
06 200 5
Coolant Temperature Sensor in Thermostat Housing Coolant Temperature Sensor in Cylinder Head Crankshaft Position Sensor Oil Pressure Sensor Manifold Air Temperature Sensor Fuel Temperature Sensor Fuel Heater
Torque
15 Nm (11 lb-ft)
Torque
35 Nm (26 lb-ft)
OUO1080,0000216 1927NOV011/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-5
PN=407
Repair Specifications
06 200 6
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-200-6
PN=408
Group 210
Diagnostic Specifications
Group 150/160 Electronic Fuel System Diagnostic Specifications
Item Measurement Specification
Static Pressure
2530 kPa (0.250.30 bar) (3.54.5 psi) 15 kPa (0.15 bar) (2.0 psi)
Minimum Static Pressure at 850 rpm Engine Speed Minimum Positive Pressure at 2400 rpm Engine Speed Minimum Flow at 2400 rpm Engine Speed
2134 kPa (0.210.34 bar) (35 psi) 1.5 L/min (0.42 gpm)
DPSG,OUO1004,2762 1917MAY001/1
06 210 1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-1
PN=409
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 2
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-2
PN=410
Diagnostic Specifications
Application Specifications
Below is an overview of the specfications listed for applications in the next few pages. Backhoes Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle Crawlers Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle Excavators Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle Forwarders Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle Harvesters Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle manual. OEM Engines Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Electronic Control System Wiring Diagram 4.5L & 6.8L OEM Application Instrument Panel/Engine Start Components Electrical Wiring Diagram Skidders Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle manual. Telehandlers Sensor Specifications Torque Curve Selection Governor Mode Selection ECU Terminal Identification Vehicle Wiring - See Vehicle manual.
manual.
manual.
manual.
manual.
06 210 3
RG40854,0000128 1929JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-3
PN=411
Diagnostic Specifications
Fuel Temperature
06 210 4
RG40854,000013A 1930JAN021/1
RG40854,000013B 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-4
PN=412
Diagnostic Specifications
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Backhoes Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop
RG40854,000013E 1930JAN021/1
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 B3 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B A B B A A A A 06 210 5
RG40854,000013F 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-5
PN=413
Diagnostic Specifications
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,0000132 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-6
PN=414
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000135 1930JAN021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Excavators Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop 06 210 7
RG40854,0000134 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-7
PN=415
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 B3 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 F3 C1
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B A B B A A A A B A
06 210 8
RG40854,0000137 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-8
PN=416
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 9
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-9
PN=417
Diagnostic Specifications
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,000012E 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-10
PN=418
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,000012F 1930JAN021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Excavators Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop
RG40854,0000131 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-11
PN=419
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 D3 F3 B3 C1 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa A B B A A A A
06 210 12
RG40854,0000130 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-12
PN=420
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 13
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-13
PN=421
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000158 1921FEB021/2
06 210 14
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-14
PN=422
Diagnostic Specifications
Sensor Specifications for Forwarders Sensor Analog Throttle (A) (1010 Forwarders ONLY) Measured Sensor Parameter High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Analog Throttle (B) (1010 Forwarders ONLY) High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Oil Pressure High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Extremely Low Pressure Out of Range Value Above 4.7 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Above 4.7 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Above 4.5 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Pressure goes below an engine speed dependent value. Above 4.9 Volts Below 0.1 Volts Exceeds 88C (190F) Derate If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. Low oil pressure engine protection is disabled. Low oil pressure engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 20% per minute until engine runs at 60% of full power. High MAT engine protection is disabled. High MAT engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power. High ECT engine protection is disabled. High ECT engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 20% per minute until engine runs at 60% of full power. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power. High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power. 06 210 15
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,0000158 1921FEB022/2
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-15
PN=423
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000159 1921FEB021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Forwarders Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 06 210 16 Conditions: Normal droop
RG40854,000015A 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-16
PN=424
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 E1 F2 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 F3
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B B A B B A A A A B
06 210 17
RG40854,000015B 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-17
PN=425
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 18
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,0000167 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-18
PN=426
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000166 1921FEB021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Harvesters Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop 06 210 19
RG40854,0000165 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-19
PN=427
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 F3
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor A B B A A A A B
06 210 20
RG40854,0000164 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-20
PN=428
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 21
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-21
PN=429
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000129 1929JAN021/3
06 210 22
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-22
PN=430
Diagnostic Specifications
Sensor Specifications for OEM Engines Sensor Analog Throttle (A) Measured Sensor Parameter High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Analog Throttle (B) High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Oil Pressure High Input Voltage Low Input Voltage Extremely Low Pressure Out of Range Value Above 4.7 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Above 4.7 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Above 4.5 Volts Below 0.3 Volts Below an extremely low engine oil pressure. This pressure increases with engine speed. Below a moderately low engine oil pressure. This pressure increases with engine speed. Above 4.9 Volts Below 0.1 Volts H engines: Exceeds 100C (212F) T engines: Exceeds 120C (248F) Exceeds 4.9 Volts Below 0.05 Volts Exceeds 118C (244F) Derate If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. If no other throttle is available, engine will run at idle speed. Low oil pressure engine protection is disabled. Low oil pressure engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 60% per minute until engine runs at 40% of full power. ECU derates engine 40% per minute until engine runs at 60% of full power. High MAT engine protection is disabled. High MAT engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power. High ECT engine protection is disabled. High ECT engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 60% per minute until engine runs at 40% of full power. ECU derates engine 40% per minute until engine runs at 60% of full power. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 95% of full power. High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. 06 210 23
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,0000129 1929JAN022/3
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-23
PN=431
Diagnostic Specifications
Sensor Specifications for OEM Engines Low Input Voltage Moderately High Temperature Below 0.1 Volts Exceeds 120C (248F) High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power.
RG40854,0000129 1929JAN023/3
06 210 24
RG40854,000012A 1929JAN021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for OEM Engines Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 0 9 10 Conditions: Normal Droop Gen Sets ONLY: Above 93% throttle at 1800 RPM Isochronous Droop
RG40854,000012B 1929JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-24
PN=432
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 E1 F2 C1 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 F3 A1 C2
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B B B A B B A A A A B May change by application May change by application 06 210 25
RG40854,000012C 1929JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-25
PN=433
Diagnostic Specifications
914
911
012
914
911
911
B1
Oil Pressure Sensor Clean Side Increase A Pressure C
911
B2
Fuel Temp
B3
Coolant Temp
B4
MAT
B5
Engine Crank Sensor
Y1
Fuel Control Solenoid A
B t
B
914 Sensor Return
B t Twisted Pair B A
463 911 448 447 493 Inject Lo 491 Inject Hi
B
904 012 905 020 012
911
012
914
467
461
428
F3
C3
B1
D3
D1
D2 B2 Sensor Return
K2
A2 Switched Battery
A1
C2 J3 F2
Cruise CANC. RES./External Derate 981 954 913 911 012 914
A
ECU Connector K3
429
A1
941
H3 H2 H1 E1 G2 B3 C1 G3 E3
936 955 923 915 474 918 947 473 439
J1
417
K1
022
J2
050
CAN L CAN H F1 G1
904 905 020 012 905 904 012
012
012
062 050 B A
85 87 87A
A B C
022 Unswitched Battery
A B C
K1
Fuel Pump Supply Relay
F02
10A
86
30
Resume Coast
Analog Throttle
911
012
914
High/Low Idle
Bump Enable
020
Bump DN
Set Accel
Bump Up
Air Heater
050
072
X11
J H G F E D C B A
050
905
904
X10
X6
T A B C D E F G H J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X
R H
429
417
X9
Fuel Heater A 050
Auxillary Connector 050 050 SE2 SE2 SE2 SE2 SE2 SE2 SE2 050
X7
UT
UT
SE2
050
X3
RG40854,0000121 1928JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-26
Cruse Brake
Tachometer
Fault Lamp
SE2
PN=434
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 27
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-27
PN=435
Diagnostic Specifications
OEM Engines - 4.5L & 6.8L Instrument Panel/Engine Start Components Electrical Wiring Diagram
RG11987 1919DEC01 914 Sensor Return 911 Sensor Excitation (+5V) 020 CAN Shield 904 CAN H 905 CAN L 012 IGN +12V OR +24V 412 ACC 422 Starter Relay Solenoid 002 BAT
412
914 Sensor Return 911 Sensor Excitation (+5V) 020 CAN Shield 904 CAN H 905 CAN L 012 IGN +12V OR +24V
914 Sensor Return 911 Sensor Excitation (+5V) 020 CAN Shield 904 CAN H 905 CAN L 012 IGN +12V OR +24V
914 Sensor Return 911 Sensor Excitation (+5V) 020 CAN Shield 904 CAN H 905 CAN L 012 IGN +12V OR +24V
X1
UT
002 BAT
002 BAT
422
002
012
911
012
S1
X3
Instrument Panel Connector B S
A X02 A
Wiring Supplied With JD Alternator
012
X3
Instrument Panel Connector
002 422
X3
Instrument Panel Connector V
904
U F
905 020
24V
911
002
002
911
022
032 B BAT
IGN G
412 012
A 10A B
+12V
022
022
002
032
411
442
925
929
929
925
442
929
925
442
929
925
442
929
925
442
929
925
442
904
905
050
411
050
411
050
411
050
411
050
OUTPUT
+12V OR +24V
+12V OR +24V
+12V OR +24V
+12V OR +24V
+12V OR +24V
Back Lighting
Back Lighting
Back Lighting
Back Lighting
+12V OR +24V
Back Lighting
BAT
936
409
955
923
2 Coil
High Idle
A B A B
A
947
390 Ohm
Low Idle
1300 Ohm
918
911
Back Lighting
S IGN
050
411
020
Out Coil
KST
Off B
A B C
All B
Off B
P1
C B A D F F
P2
D A B C F
P3
D A B C F
P4
D A B C F
P5
D A B C A H E
P6
D C G B F
012
A B C A B C
Data +
Data + Data -
Data + Data -
Data + Data -
Data + Data -
915
474
SPG
SPG
SPG
SPG
SPG
050
050
002
022
442
050
442 411
Bump Up
442
925
925
925
925
925
A B
020 905 904
032
ALT 12V
SPG
S B
Data + Data -
Data -
N1
G1
M1
X5
929
929
929
929
929
12V
S4
GND
F1
Analog Throttle
S2
S3
S5
Dimmer Option A B A B
X3
Instrument Panel E Connector
050 SPG 947 918 915 474
C B A C B A
SAE J1939/11 3-Way Deutsch Conn Back Light No Dimmer Back Light Dimmer High (CW) Low
050
050
002
X4
Single Point Ground 050
022
SE3
SE3 SE3
SE3
SE3
SE3
SE3
SE3
050 SPG
050 SPG
RG40854,0000122 1928JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-28
PN=436
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 29
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-29
PN=437
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 30
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,000016C 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-30
PN=438
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,000016D 1921FEB021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Skidders Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop 06 210 31
RG40854,000016F 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-31
PN=439
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 E1 C1 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 F3
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B B A B B A A A A B
06 210 32
RG40854,0000170 1921FEB021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-32
PN=440
Diagnostic Specifications
06 210 33
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-33
PN=441
Diagnostic Specifications
High MAT engine protection is disabled. High MAT engine protection is disabled. High ECT engine protection is disabled. High ECT engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 20% per minute until engine runs at 40% of full power. ECU derates engine 20% per minute until engine runs at 60% of full power. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power. High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. High fuel temperature engine protection is disabled. ECU derates engine 2% per minute until engine runs at 80% of full power.
06 210 34
Fuel Temperature
RG40854,0000140 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-34
PN=442
Diagnostic Specifications
RG40854,0000141 1930JAN021/1
Max. Speed Governor Selection for Telehandlers Mode Selected on DST or SERVICE ADVISOR 9 Conditions: Normal droop 06 210 35
RG40854,0000142 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-35
PN=443
Diagnostic Specifications
ECU Terminal # A2 K1 J2 G1 F1 E2 D3 E1 B2 D2 A3 K2 C3 B1 D1 C1
Sensor Connector Terminal# N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa N/Aa NA Changes with each sensor Changes with each sensor B A B B A A A A Refer to vehicle manual for this.
06 210 36
RG40854,0000143 1930JAN021/1
CTM331 (09APR02)
06-210-36
PN=444
Index
Page Page
A
Air heater, intake Diagnostic check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Air in fuel test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-49 Air temperature sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-6 Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 Application specifications Backhoes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Crawlers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Forwarders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Harvesters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 OEM engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Skidders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Telehandlers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3
Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-3 Cruise control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Cylinder misfire test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-56
D
Data parameter description . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-16 Derate programs Application specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Diagnostic Gauge Clearing stored codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-13 Diagnostics ACP-Err/Bus EP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 ACP-Err/Bus Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 ACP-Err/No Addr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 Does not communicate with ECU . . . .04-150-36 EE-error. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 Engine configuration parameters. . . . . . .04-160-10 Viewing active codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Viewing stored codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Diagnostic Scan Tool (DST) Data parameter description . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-16 Diagnostics ECU does not communicate with DST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-32 Tests Excavator torque curve change . . . . . .04-160-19 Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) Active engine codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Active vs. inactive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-15 Blinking Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-15 Clearing engine codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-13 Clearing stored codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-15 Diagnosing intermittent faults . . . . . . . . .04-160-28 Diagnostic procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-27 Listing of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-22 SPN/FMI codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-22 2-digit codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 Other F4A0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4A5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4A7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4EA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4ED. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4E0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F4E3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F400 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F401 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F402 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F403 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 4.5 L & 6.8 L Level 12 Electronic Fuel System
040902
B
Bio-Diesel fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-2 Bleed fuel system . . . . . . . . . . . 02-090-26, 04-150-53
C
CAN definition of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-11 Check Fuel supply pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-50 Fuel supply quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-47 Circuit malfunctions Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-4 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-5 Connectors, electrical AMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-20 DEUTSCH, repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-17 General information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-6 METRI-PACK, pull type. . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-12 METRI-PACK, push type . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-14 Remove blade terminals from connector body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-11 Controller Area Network (CAN), operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-11 Coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1 Coolant temperature sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-5 Remove and install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Crank sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 CTM331 (09APR02)
Indx 1
Index-1
PN=1
Index
Page
Page
Indx 2
F404 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F405 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F411 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F413 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F414 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F415 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F416 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F418 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F419 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F420 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F421 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F422 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F423 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F424 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F425 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F426 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F428 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F429 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F430 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F432 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F436 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F439 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F440 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F445 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F446 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F459 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F460 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F461 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F463 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F464 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F465 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F470 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F474 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F475 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F476 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F477 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F48B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F49A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F490 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F491 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F492 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F493 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 F494 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 SPN/FMI SPN 0028 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0028 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0029 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0029 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0029 FMI 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 07 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 CTM331 (09APR02)
SPN 0091 FMI 09 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0091 FMI 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-86 SPN 0100 FMI 01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-88 SPN 0100 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-92 SPN 0100 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-96 SPN 0100 FMI 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-102 SPN 0105 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-104 SPN 0105 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-108 SPN 0105 FMI 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-112 SPN 0110 FMI 00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-114 SPN 0110 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-116 SPN 0110 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-120 SPN 0110 FMI 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-124 SPN 0110 FMI 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-126 SPN 0111 FMI 00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-128 SPN 0111 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-130 SPN 0111 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-134 SPN 0158 FMI 17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-138 SPN 0174 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-142 SPN 0174 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-146 SPN 0174 FMI 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-150 SPN 0190 FMI 00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-154 SPN 0190 FMI 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-155 SPN 0620 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-156 SPN 0620 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-160 SPN 0627 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-164 SPN 0629 FMI 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-168 SPN 0637 FMI 02 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-170 SPN 0637 FMI 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-174 SPN 0639 FMI 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-178 SPN 0898 FMI 09 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-181 SPN 0970 FMI 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-182 SPN 0971 FMI 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-183 SPN 1076 FMI 00 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-184 SPN 1076 FMI 01 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-188 SPN 1076 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-192 SPN 1076 FMI 05 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-196 SPN 1076 FMI 06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-200 SPN 1076 FMI 07 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-204 SPN 1079 FMI 03 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-212 SPN 1079 FMI 04 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-216 SPN 1109 FMI 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-220 SPN 1110 FMI 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-221 SPN 1569 FMI 31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-222 SPN 2000 FMI 06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-223 SPN 2000 FMI 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-224 Stored engine codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-15 2-Digit codes DTC 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 4.5 L & 6.8 L Level 12 Electronic Fuel System
040902
Index-2
PN=2
Index
Page
Page
DTC 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 19 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 22 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 25 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 26 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 38 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 42 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 62 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 63 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 65 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 68 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 69 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 71 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 72 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 73 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 74 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 75 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 76 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 77 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 79 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 81 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 82 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 83 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 84 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 DTC 88 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-24 Diagnostics Air heater check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Fuel system Excessive fuel consumption. . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Fuel in oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Supply system check. . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-26 Observable Abnormal engine noise . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-23 Analog Throttle (B) does not respond . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-25 ECU does not communicate with Diagnostic Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 ECU does not communicate with DST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-32 CTM331 (09APR02)
ECU does not communicate with Service ADVISOR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-32 Engine cranks/wont start. . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-2 Engine does not develop full power . . .04-150-11 Engine emits excessive black or gray exhaust smoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-19 Engine emits excessive white exhaust smoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-16 Engine idles poorly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-22 Engine misfires/runs irregularly . . . . . . .04-150-7 Engine will not crank . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-22 OEM wiring diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-26 Diesel fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1 Digital multimeter, how to use . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2 DST Connecting to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-14 Definition of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 DTC Definition of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2
E
ECU Definition of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-10 Repair and adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-1 Electrical circuit Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2 Malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-5 Electrical Concepts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-1 Electrical connectors AMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-20 DEUTSCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-17 General information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-6 METRI-PACK . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-12, 02-110-14 WEATHERPACK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-8 Electrical insulating compound . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-6 Electronic control system Air heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Analog throttle operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 CAN throttle operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Cruise control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Derating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Engine protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Excavator throttle operation . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Governor modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14 Measuring engine speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Measuring pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-7 Measuring temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-5 Monitoring engine parameters. . . . . . . . . .03-140-3 4.5 L & 6.8 L Level 12 Electronic Fuel System
040902
Indx 3
Index-3
PN=3
Index
Page
Page
Multi-state throttle operation . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Operation, theory of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-3 Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-4 Pump solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Engine Application charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-4 Model designation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-1 Serial number plate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-2 Engine configuration parameters . . . . . . . .04-160-10 Engine Control Unit (ECU) Operation, theory of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-10 Repair and adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-1 Self-diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-15 Engine cranks/wont start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-2 Engine does not develop full power . . . . . .04-150-11 Engine emits excessive black or gray exhaust smoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-19 Engine emits excessive white exhaust smoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-16 Engine idles poorly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-22 Engine misfires/runs irregularly. . . . . . . . . . .04-150-7 Engine noise, abnormal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-23 Engine Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-13 Engine will not crank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-22
F
FMI, definition of. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Fuel Bio-Diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-2 Diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1 Lubricity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-3 Fuel drain back test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-48 Fuel filter Exploded view (final). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-6 Exploded view (primary) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-5 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-5 Remove and install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-2 Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-7 Fuel heater Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-5 Fuel injection nozzles Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-23 Bore, clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Diagnose malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-30 Disassemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-22 Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-25 Opening pressure test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-21 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-8 Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-16 CTM331 (09APR02)
Indx 4
Seal installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-24 Spray pattern test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-20 Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-19 Valve seat checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-20 Valve stem and guide wear checking . . .02-090-20 Fuel injection pump Inspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-13 Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-13 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-6 Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-11 Static timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-10 Fuel supply pump Bench test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-51 Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-10 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-4 Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-9 Fuel system Air in fuel test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-49 Bleed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-26, 04-150-53 Cylinder misfire test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-56 Diagnostics Excessive fuel consumption. . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Fuel in oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-29 Supply system check. . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-26 Fuel drain back test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-48 Fuel supply pressure check . . . . . . . . . .04-150-50 Fuel supply quality check . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-47 General information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-1 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-2 Relieve pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-1 Supply pressure specifications . . . . . . . . .06-210-1 Fuel temperature sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-7 Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4
G
Glossary of terms Electronic control system . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Governor mode Application specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14
H
Heater, air intake Diagnostic check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 High pressure washer, using with electrical components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-7 4.5 L & 6.8 L Level 12 Electronic Fuel System
040902
Index-4
PN=4
Index
Page
Page
I
Inch torque values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-1 Injection nozzles Bore, clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-18 Diagnose malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-30 Disassemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-22 Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-25 Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-090-16 Injection pump Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-130-6 Solenoid operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Instrument panel (OEM) Blinking codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-15 Clearing stored codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-13 Diagnostic gauge diagnostics . . . . . . . . .04-150-36 Viewing active codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Viewing stored codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-12 Wiring diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-28 Intake air heater Diagnostic check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-12 Intermittent fault, diagnosing. . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-28
S
Sensor, operation Coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-5 Crank position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-9 Fuel temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-7 Loss of coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-6 Manifold air temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-6 Oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Sensor, replace Coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Crank position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-3 Fuel temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 Loss of coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Manifold air temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 Oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-3 Serial number plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-001-2 Service ADVISOR Conecting to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-14 Data parameter description . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-16 Diagnostics ECU does not communicate with Sevice ADVISOR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-32 Tests Excavator torque curve change . . . . . .04-160-19 Specifications Backhoes ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-5 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-5 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-4 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-4 Crawlers ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-8 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-7 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-6 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-7 Excavators ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-12 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-11 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-10 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-11 Forwarders ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-17 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-16 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-14 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-16 Fuel supply pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-1 General OEM engine specifications . . . . .06-200-3 Harvesters ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-20 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-19 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-18 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-19 4.5 L & 6.8 L Level 12 Electronic Fuel System
040902
L
Loss of coolant temperature sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-6 Remove and install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-2 Lubricants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .01-002-1
Indx 5
M
Manifold air temperature sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-6 Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-4 MAT, definition of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Metric torque values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-2 Misfire test, cylinder Cylinder misfire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-56 Multimeter, how to use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-2
O
Oil pressure sensor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .02-110-3 CTM331 (09APR02)
Index-5
PN=5
Index
Page
Page
OEM engines ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-25 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-24 Instrument panel wiring diagram . . . . .06-210-28 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-22 Start components wiring diagram. . . . .06-210-28 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-24 Wiring diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-26 Skidders ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-32 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-31 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-30 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-31 Telehandlers ECU terminal identification. . . . . . . . . .06-210-36 Governor mode selection. . . . . . . . . . .06-210-35 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-34 Torque curve selection . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-35 Speed governing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14 SPN, definition of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-2 Start components Wiring diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-28
T
Test Air heater check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-42 Air in fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-49 Cylinder misfire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-56 Excavator torque curve change. . . . . . . .04-160-19 Fuel drain back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-48 Fuel supply pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-50 Fuel supply quality check . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-47 Fuel supply system check . . . . . . . . . . . .04-150-26 Throttle DTCs Listing of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-29, 04-160-86 T01 - Multi-state throttle input high . . . . .04-160-30 T02 - Multi-state throttle input low . . . . . .04-160-34 T03 - Analog throttle (A) input high . . . . .04-160-38 T04 - Analog throttle (A) input low . . . . .04-160-42 T05 - Analog throttle (B) input high . . . . .04-160-46 T06 - Analog throttle (B) input low . . . . .04-160-50 T07 - CAN throttle invalid . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-54 T11 - Excavator throttle reference voltage high . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-58 T12 - Excavator throttle reference voltage low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-62 T13 - Excavator throttle ground voltage high . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-66 T14 - Excavator throttle ground voltage low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-70 CTM331 (09APR02)
T15 - Excavator throttle input voltage high . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-74 T16 - Excavator throttle input voltage low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-78 T19 - Throttle not calibrated properly . . .04-160-81 T20 - Throttle input voltage below lower calibration limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-82 T21 - Throttle calibration aborted . . . . . .04-160-83 T22 - Analog throttle (A) input voltage out of range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-84 T23 - Multi-state throttle input voltage out of range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-85 Throttle, operation Analog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 CAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Excavator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Multi-state . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-8 Tools Electronic Fuel System Diagnostic . . . . . .05-180-1 Torque curve selection Application specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-3 Excavator change test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-19 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .03-140-14 Torque values Inch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-1 Metric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-200-2 Trouble codes Diagnostic procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-27 Listing of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .04-160-22
Indx 6
W
Wiring diagram Instrument panel (OEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-28 OEM engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .06-210-26
Index-6
PN=6